ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 AMERICAN NATIONAL STANDARD STANDARD FOR MAINTENANCE TESTING SPECIFICATIONS for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems Secretariat NETA (InterNational Electrical Testing Association) Approved by American National Standards Institute – This page intentionally left blank – American National Standard Approval of an American National Standard requires verification by ANSI that the requirements for due process, consensus, and other criteria for approval have been met by the standards developer. Consensus is established when, in the judgment of the ANSI Board of Standards Review, substantial agreement has been reached by directly and materially affected interests. Substantial agreement means much more than a simple majority, but not necessarily unanimity. Consensus requires that all views and objections be considered, and that a concerted effort be made toward their resolution. The use of American National Standards is completely voluntary; their existence does not in any respect preclude anyone, whether he has approved the standards or not, from manufacturing, marketing, purchasing, or using products, processes, or procedures not conforming to the standards. The American National Standards Institute does not develop standards and will in no circumstances give an interpretation of any American National Standard in the name of the American National Standards Institute. Requests for interpretations should be addressed to the secretariat or sponsor whose name appears on the title page of this standard. Caution Notice: This American National Standard may be revised or withdrawn at any time. The procedures of the American National Standards Institute require that action be taken periodically to reaffirm, revise, or withdraw this standard. Purchasers of American National Standards may receive current information on all standards by calling or writing the American National Standards Institute. Published by InterNational Electrical Testing Association 3050 Old Centre Ave., Suite 102 Portage, MI 49024 269.488.6382· FAX 269.488.6383 www.netaworld.org neta@netaworld.org Jayne Tanz - Executive Director Copyright© 2011 InterNational Electrical Testing Association All rights reserved Printed in the United States of America No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form, in an electronic retrieval system or otherwise, without the prior written permission of the publisher. ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Copyright Information and Alteration of Content 2011 ANSI/NETA Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications is protected under the copyright laws of the United States, and all rights are reserved. Further, the Standard may not be copied, modified, sold, or used except in accordance with such laws and as follows: Purchasers may reproduce and use all or a portion of the Standard provided ANSI/NETA Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications is clearly identified in writing as the source of all such uses or reproductions. Section 7 of the ANSI/NETA Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications may be reproduced and used on a “cut and paste” basis for the particular type of equipment to be tested. The following sections of the ANSI/NETA Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications must be incorporated by reference as part of any subsection: 3. 4. 5. Qualifications of Testing Organization and Personnel 3.1 Testing Organization 3.2 Testing Personnel Division of Responsibility 4.1 The Owner’s Representative 4.2 The Testing Organization General 5.1 Safety and Precaution 5.2 Suitability of Test Equipment 5.3 Test Instrument Calibration 5.4 Test Report The purchaser is required to include the above sections with any section(s) of 7. © Copyright 2011 InterNational Electrical Testing Association 3050 Old Centre Ave., Suite 102 Portage, MI 49024 Voice: 888.300.6382 Facsimile: 269.488.6383 E-mail: neta@netaworld.org • Web: www.netaworld.org ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Standards Review Council The following persons were members of the NETA Standards Review Council which approved this document. Charles K. Blizard, Sr. Timothy J. Cotter Diane W. Hageman Roderic L. Hageman Dave Huffman Ralph Patterson Alan D. Peterson Jayne Tanz Ron Widup Maintenance Testing Specifications Section Panel Members The following persons were members of the Section Panel which balloted on this document for submission to the NETA Standards Review Council. Mark Baldwin Ken Bassett Tom Bishop Scott Blizard Michael Bowers Alan Bump John Cadick Michel Canstonguay Ernie Creech Tim Crnko Don Genutis Kerry Heid Stuart Jackson Scott Kinney Andrew Kobler Korey Kruse Benjamin Lanz Mark Lautenschlager Joe Nims Bruce Olson ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Jerry Parnell Raj Patel Tony Perry M. Lee Perry, Jr. Mose Ramieh, Sr. Vince Saporita Richard Sobhraj ChrisWerstiuk John White J.P. Wolff NETA Accredited Companies The following persons were voting members of the InterNational Electrical Testing Association when this document was approved on May 16, 2011. A&F Electrical Testing., Inc. Kevin Chilton Advanced Testing Systems Patrick MacCarthy American Electrical Testing Co., Inc. Scott Blizard Apparatus Testing and Engineering James Lawler Applied Engineering Concepts Michel Castonguay Burlington Electrical Testing Company, Inc. C.E. Testing., Inc. Walter Cleary Mark Chapman CE Power Solutions of Wisconsin, LLC James VanHandel DYMAX Holdings, Inc. Gene Philipp Eastern High Voltage Joseph Wilson ELECT, P.C. Barry W. Tyndall Electric Power Systems, Inc. Steve Reed Electrical and Electronic Controls Michael Hughes Electrical Energy Experts, Inc. William Styer Electrical Equipment Upgrading, Inc. Kevin Miller Electrical Maintenance & Testing, Inc. Brian Borst Electrical Reliability Services Lee Bigham Electrical Testing, Inc. Steve Dodd Elemco Services, Inc. Robert J. White Hampton Tedder Technical Services Matt Tedder Harford Electrical Testing Co., Inc. Vincent Biondino High Energy Electrical Testing, Inc. James P. Ratshin High Voltage Maintenance Corp. Eric Nation HMT, Inc. John Pertgen Industrial Electric Testing, Inc. Gary Benzenberg Industrial Electronics Group Butch E. Teal Industrial Tests, Inc. Greg Poole Infra-Red Building and Power Service Thomas McDonald ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 NETA Accredited Companies M&L Power Systems Maintenance, Inc. Darshan Arora Magna Electric Corporation Kerry Heid Magna IV Engineering – Edmonton Jereme Wentzell Magna IV Engineering (BC), Ltd. Cameron Hite MET Electrical Testing, LLC William McKenzie National Field Services Eric Beckman Nationwide Electrical Testing, Inc. Shashikant B. Bagle North Central Electric, Inc. Robert Messina Northern Electrical Testing, Inc. Lyle Detterman Orbis Engineering Field Services Lorne Gara Pacific Power Testing, Inc. Steve Emmert Phasor Engineering Rafael Castro Potomac Testing, Inc. Ken Bassett Power & Generation Testing, Inc. Mose Ramieh Power Engineering Services, Inc. Miles R. Engelke POWER PLUS Engineering, Inc. Salvatore Mancuso Power Products & Solutions, Inc. Ralph Patterson Power Services, LLC Gerald Bydash Power Systems Testing Co. David Huffman Power Test, Inc. Richard Walker POWER Testing and Energization, Inc. Chris Zavadlov Powertech Services, Inc. Jean A. Brown Precision Testing Group Glenn Stuckey PRIT Service, Inc. Roderic Hageman Reuter & Hanney, Inc. Michael Reuter REV Engineering, LTD Roland Davidson Scott Testing, Inc. Russ Sorbello Shermco Industries Ron Widup Sigma Six Solutions, Inc. John White Southern New England Electrical Testing David Asplund, Sr. ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 NETA Accredited Companies Southwest Energy Systems, LLC Robert Sheppard Taurus Power and Controls, Inc. Rob Bulfinch Three-C Electrical Co., Inc. James Cialdea Tidal Power Services, LLC Monty Janak Tony Demaria Electric, Inc. Anthony Demaria Trace Electrical Services & Testing, LLC Joseph Vasta Utilities Instrumentation Service, Inc. Gary Walls Utility Service Corporation Alan Peterson Western Electrical Services Dan Hook ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 NOTICE In no event shall the InterNational Electrical Testing Association be liable to anyone for special, collateral, incidental, or consequential damages in connection with or arising out of the use of these materials. This document is subject to periodic review, and users are cautioned to obtain the latest edition. Comments and suggestions are invited from all users for consideration by the Association in connection with such review. Any such suggestions will be fully reviewed by the Association after giving the commenter, upon request, a reasonable opportunity to be heard. This document should not be confused with federal, state, or municipal specifications or regulations, insurance requirements, or national safety codes. While the Association recommends reference to or use of this document by government agencies and others, use of this document is purely voluntary and not binding. InterNational Electrical Testing Association 3050 Old Centre Ave., Suite 102 • Portage, MI 49024 Voice: 888.300.6382 Facsimile: 269.488.6383 Email: neta@netaworld.org • Web: www.netaworld.org Jayne Tanz, CMP - Executive Director ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 FOREWORD (This Foreword is not part of American National Standard ANSI/NETA MTS-2011) The InterNational Electrical Testing Association (NETA) was formed in 1972 to establish uniform testing procedures for electrical equipment and apparatus. NETA has been an Accredited Standards Developer for the American National Standards Institute since 1996. NETA’s scope of standards activity is different from that of IEEE, NECA, NEMA, and UL. In matters of testing electrical equipment and systems NETA continues to reference other standards developers’ documents where applicable. NETA’s review and updating of presently published standards takes into account both national and international standards. NETA’s standards may be used internationally as well as in the United States. NETA firmly endorses a global standardization. IEC standards as well as American consensus standards are taken into consideration by NETA’s ballot pools and reviewing committees. The first NETA Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems was published in 1975. Since 1989, revised editions of the Maintenance Testing Specifications have been published in 1993, 1997, and 2001. In 2005, this document was approved for the first time as an American National Standard. The 2011 Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems is the most current revision of this document. The ANSI/NETA Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems was developed for use by those responsible for the continued operation of existing electrical systems and equipment to guide them in specifying and performing the necessary tests to ensure that these systems and apparatus perform satisfactorily, minimizing downtime and maximizing life expectancy. This document aids in ensuring safe, reliable operation of existing electrical power systems and equipment. Maintenance testing can identify potential problem areas before they become major problems requiring expensive and time-consuming solutions. Suggestions for improvement of this standard are welcome. They should be sent to the InterNational Electrical Testing Association, 3050 Old Centre Avenue, Suite 102, Portage, MI 49024. ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 PREFACE It is recognized by the Association that the needs for maintenance testing of commercial, industrial, governmental, and other electrical power systems vary widely. Many criteria are used in determining what equipment is to be tested and to what extent. To help the user better understand and navigate more efficiently through this document, we offer the following information: The Document Structure The document is divided into twelve separate and defined sections: Section Section 1 Section 2 Section 3 Section 4 Section 5 Section 6 Section 7 Section 8 Section 9 Section 10 Tables Appendices Description General Scope Applicable References Qualifications of Testing Organization and Personnel Division of Responsibility General Power System Studies Inspection and Test Procedures System Function Test Thermographic Survey Electromagnetic Field Testing Reference Tables Various Informational Documents Section 7 Structure Section 7 is the main body of the document with specific information on what to do relative to the inspection and maintenance testing of electrical power distribution equipment and systems. It is not intended that this document explain how to test specific pieces of equipment or systems. Expected Test Results Section 7 consists of sections specific to each particular type of equipment. Within those sections there are, typically, three main bodies of information: 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 2. Electrical Tests 3. Test Values ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 PREFACE (continued) Results of Visual and Mechanical Inspections Some, but not all, visual and mechanical inspections have an associated test value or result. Those items with an expected result are referenced under Section 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical. For example, Section 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies, item 7.1.1.7.2 calls for verifying tightness of connections using a calibrated torque wrench method. Under the Test Values – Visual and Mechanical Section 7.1.3. 1.2, the expected results for that particular task are listed within Section 3.1, with reference back to the original task description on item 7.1.1.7.2. ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 PREFACE (continued) Results of Electrical Tests Each electrical test has a corresponding expected result, and the test and the result have identical numbers. If the electrical test is item four, the expected result under the Test Values section is also item four. For example, under Section 7.15.1 Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators, item 7.15.1.2.2 (item 2 within the Electrical Tests section) calls for performing an insulation-resistance test in accordance with IEEE Standard 43. Under the Test Values – Electrical section, the expected results for that particular task are listed in the Test Values section under item 2. ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 PREFACE (continued) Optional Tests The purpose of these specifications is to assure that all tested electrical equipment and systems supplied by either contractor or owner are operational and within applicable standards and manufacturer’s published tolerances and that equipment and systems are installed in accordance with design specifications. Certain tests are assigned an optional classification. The following considerations are used in determining the use of the optional classification: 1. 2. 3. Does another listed test provide similar information? How does the cost of the test compare to the cost of other tests providing similar information? How commonplace is the test procedure? Is it new technology? Manufacturer’s Instruction Manuals It is important to follow the recommendations contained in the manufacturer’s published data. Many of the details of a complete and effective testing procedure can be obtained from this source. Summary The guidance of an experienced testing professional should be sought when making decisions concerning the extent of testing. It is necessary to make an informed judgment for each particular system regarding how extensive a procedure is justified. The approach taken in these specifications is to present a comprehensive series of tests applicable to most industrial and larger commercial systems. In smaller systems, some of the tests can be deleted. In other cases, a number of the tests indicated as optional should be performed. Likewise, guidance of an experienced testing professional should also be sought when making decisions concerning the results of test data and their significance to the overall analysis of the device or system under test. Careful consideration of all aspects of test data, including manufacturer’s published data and recommendations, must be included in the overall assessment of the device or system under test. The Association encourages comment from users of this document. Please contact the NETA office or your local NETA Accredited Company. Standards Review Council InterNational Electrical Testing Association Charles K. Blizard, Sr. Timothy J. Cotter Diane W. Hageman Roderic L. Hageman Dave Huffman Ralph Patterson Alan D. Peterson Jayne Tanz Ron Widup ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 CONTENTS 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. GENERAL SCOPE .................................................................................................................. APPLICABLE REFERENCES ................................................................................................ QUALIFICATIONS OF TESTING PERSONNEL ................................................................. DIVISION OF RESPONSIBILITY .......................................................................................... GENERAL ................................................................................................................................ 5.1 Safety and Precautions ............................................................................................ 5.2 Suitability of Test Equipment ................................................................................. 5.3 Test Instrument Calibration .................................................................................... 5.4 Test Report .............................................................................................................. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES .................................................................................................. 6.1 Short-Circuit Studies............................................................................................... 6.2 Coordination Studies............................................................................................... 6.3 Arc-Flash Hazard Analysis ..................................................................................... 6.4 Load-Flow Studies .................................................................................................. 6.5 Stability Studies ...................................................................................................... 6.6 Harmonic-Analysis Studies .................................................................................... INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES ............................................................................ 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies ............................................................... 7.2.1.1 Transformers, Dry-Type, Air-Cooled, Low-Voltage, Small .................................. 7.2.1.2 Transformers, Dry-Type, Air-Cooled, Large .......................................................... 7.2.2 Transformers, Liquid-Filled.................................................................................... 7.3.1 Cables, Low-Voltage, Low-Energy – Reserved ..................................................... 7.3.2 Cables, Low-Voltage, 600 Volt Maximum............................................................. 7.3.3 Cables, Medium- and High-Voltage ....................................................................... 7.4 Metal-Enclosed Busways ........................................................................................ 7.5.1.1 Switches, Air, Low-Voltage ................................................................................... 7.5.1.2 Switches, Air, Medium-Voltage, Metal-Enclosed .................................................. 7.5.1.3 Switches, Air, Medium- and High-Voltage, Open ................................................. 7.5.2 Switches, Oil, Medium-Voltage ............................................................................. 7.5.3 Switches, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage ..................................................................... 7.5.4 Switches, SF6, Medium-Voltage ............................................................................. 7.5.5 Switches, Cutouts.................................................................................................... 7.6.1.1 Circuit Breakers, Air, Insulated-Case/Molded-Case .............................................. 7.6.1.2 Circuit Breakers, Air, Low-Voltage Power ............................................................ 7.6.1.3 Circuit Breakers, Air, Medium-Voltage ................................................................. 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage ................................................ 7.6.3 Circuit Breakers, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage ......................................................... 7.6.4 Circuit Breakers, SF6 .............................................................................................. 7.7 Circuit Switchers ..................................................................................................... ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 1 2 11 12 13 13 13 14 15 16 16 17 19 21 22 23 24 24 28 30 34 38 39 41 44 46 49 52 55 58 61 64 66 69 73 77 82 86 90 CONTENTS (continued) 7.8 7.9.1 7.9.2 7.10 7.11.1 7.11.2 7.12.1.1 7.12.1.2 7.12.2 7.12.3 7.13 7.14 7.15.1 7.15.2 7.15.3 7.16.1.1 7.16.1.2 7.16.2.1 7.16.2.2 7.17 7.18.1.1 7.18.1.2 7.18.1.3 7.18.2 7.18.3 7.19.1 7.19.2 7.20.1 7.20.2 7.20.3.1 7.20.3.2 7.21 7.22.1 7.22.2 7.22.3 7.23 7.24.1 8. 9. 10. 11. Network Protectors, 600-Volt Class ....................................................................... Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State ........................................... Protective Relays, Microprocessor-Based .............................................................. Instrument Transformers ......................................................................................... Metering Devices, Electromechanical and Solid-State ........................................... Metering Devices, Microprocessor-Based .............................................................. Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step-Voltage Regulators ..................................... Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Induction Regulators ........................................... Regulating Apparatus, Current – Reserved ............................................................ Regulating Apparatus, Load Tap-Changers ............................................................ Grounding Systems ................................................................................................. Ground-Fault Protection Systems, Low-Voltage .................................................... Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators ................................... Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators .................................... Rotating Machinery, DC Motors and Generators ................................................... Motor Control, Motor Starters, Low-Voltage ......................................................... Motor Control, Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage................................................... Motor Control, Motor Control Centers, Low-Voltage............................................ Motor Control, Motor Control Centers, Medium-Voltage ..................................... Adjustable-Speed Drive Systems ............................................................................ Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Flooded Lead-Acid ......................................... Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Vented Nickel-Cadmium ................................ Direct Current Systems, Batteries, Valve-Regulated Lead-Acid............................ Direct-Current Systems, Chargers .......................................................................... Direct-Current Systems, Rectifiers – Reserved ...................................................... Surge Arresters, Low-Voltage Surge Protection Devices....................................... Surge Arresters, Medium- and High-Voltage Surge Protection Devices ............... Capacitors and Reactors, Capacitors....................................................................... Capacitors and Reactors, Capacitor Control Devices – Reserved .......................... Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Dry-Type........ Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Liquid-Filled .. Outdoor Bus Structures ........................................................................................... Emergency Systems, Engine Generator .................................................................. Emergency Systems, Uninterruptible Power Systems ............................................ Emergency Systems, Automatic Transfer Switches ............................................... Communications – Reserved .................................................................................. Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum ....................................................... 7.24.2 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers Automatic Line Sectionalizers, Oil ................................................................... 7.25 Fiber-Optic Cables .................................................................................................. SYSTEM FUNCTION TESTS ................................................................................................. THERMOGRAPHIC SURVEY ............................................................................................... ELECTROMAGNETIC FIELD TESTING ............................................................................. CORONA STUDIES – RESERVED........................................................................................ ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 93 97 104 106 112 114 116 121 125 126 130 132 135 139 145 148 151 155 155 156 159 162 165 167 169 170 172 174 176 177 179 183 185 187 190 193 194 198 201 202 203 204 205 CONTENTS (continued) TABLES 100.1 Insulation Resistance Test Values, Electrical Apparatus and Systems.................................. 100.2 Switchgear Withstand Test Voltages ..................................................................................... 100.3 Dissipation Factor/Power Factor at 20° C; Liquid-Filled Transformers, Regulators and Reactors, Maintenance Test Values .............................................................. 100.4 Insulating Fluid Limits 100.4.1 Suggested Limits for Class I Insulating Oil, Mineral Oil ....................................... 100.4.2 Suggested Limits for Less-Flammable Hydrocarbon Insulating Liquid................. 100.4.3 Suggested Limits for Service-Aged Silicone Insulating Liquid ............................. 100.4.4 Suggested Limits for Service-Aged Tetrachloroethylene Insulating Fluid ............ 100.5 Transformer Insulation Resistance, Maintenance Testing ..................................................... 100.6 Cables, Maintenance Test Values 100.6.1 Medium-Voltage Cables, Maintenance Test Values, DC Test Voltages ................ 100.6.2 Field Test Voltages for Laminated Dielectric, Shielded Power Cable Systems Rated 5,000 Volts and Above with High DC Voltage ............................................ 100.6.3 Very Low Frequency Testing Levels for Medium-Voltage Cable 0.1 Hz Test Voltage (rms) ....................................................................................... 100.7 Molded-Case Circuit Breakers, Inverse Time Trip Test ........................................................ 100.8 Instantaneous Trip Tolerances for Field Testing of Circuit Breakers.................................... 100.9 Instrument Transformer Dielectric Tests, Field Maintenance ............................................... 100.10 Maximum Allowable Vibration Amplitude ........................................................................... 100.11 Withdrawn ........................................................................................................................... 100.12 Bolt-Torque Values for Electrical Connections, US Standard Fasteners 100.12.1 Heat-Treated Steel – Cadmium or Zinc Plated ....................................................... 100.12.2 Silicon Bronze Fasteners, Torque (Pound-Feet) ..................................................... 100.12.3 Aluminum Alloy Fasteners, Torque (Pound-Feet) ................................................. 100.12.4 Stainless Steel Fasteners, Torque (Pound-Feet)...................................................... 100.13 SF6 Gas Tests ......................................................................................................................... 100.14 Insulation Resistance Conversion Factors 100.14.1 Insulation Resistance Conversion Factors (20° C) ................................................. 100.14.2 Insulation Resistance Conversion Factors (40° C) ................................................. 100.15 High-Potential Test Voltage for Automatic Circuit Reclosers .............................................. 100.16 High-Potential Test Voltage for Periodic Test of Line Sectionalizers .................................. 100.17 Metal-Enclosed Bus Dielectric Withstand Test Voltages ...................................................... 100.18 Thermographic Survey, Suggested Actions Based on Temperature Rise ............................. 100.19 Dielectric Withstand Test Voltages for Electrical Apparatus Other than Inductive Equipment ............................................................................................ 100.20 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers 100.20.1 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers............................. 100.20.2 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers, Soleniod-Operated Devices .................................................................................... 100.21 Accuracy of IEC Class TP Current Transformers, Error Limit ............................................. 100.22 Minimum Radii for Power Cable ........................................................................................... 208 209 210 211 212 213 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 223 224 224 225 226 227 228 229 230 231 232 233 235 236 237 APPENDICES Appendix A – Definitions ..................................................................................................................... 241 Appendix B – Frequency of Maintenance Tests ................................................................................... 243 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 CONTENTS (continued) Appendix C – About the InterNational Electrical Testing Association ................................................ 247 Appendix D – Form for Comments ...................................................................................................... 249 Appendix E – Form for Proposals ........................................................................................................ 250 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 1. GENERAL SCOPE 1.1 Maintenance Testing Specifications 1. These specifications cover the suggested field tests and inspections that are available to assess the suitability for continued service and reliability of electrical power distribution equipment and systems. 2. The purpose of these specifications is to assure that tested electrical equipment and systems are operational, are within applicable standards and manufacturer’s tolerances, and are suitable for continued service. 3. The work specified in these specifications may involve hazardous voltages, materials, operations, and equipment. These specifications do not purport to address all of the safety problems associated with their use. It is the responsibility of the user to review all applicable regulatory limitations prior to the use of these specifications. Page 1 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications All inspections and field tests shall be in accordance with the latest edition of the following codes, standards, and specifications except as provided otherwise herein. 1. American National Standards Institute – ANSI 2. ASTM International – ASTM ASTM D 92 Standard Test Method for Flash and Fire Points by Cleveland Open Cup Tester ASTM D 445 Standard Test Method for Kinematic Viscosity of Transparent and Opaque Liquids (the Calculation of Dynamic Viscosity) ASTM D 664 Standard Test Method for Acid Number of Petroleum Products by Potentiometric Titration ASTM D 877 Standard Test Method for Dielectric Breakdown Voltage of Insulating Liquids using Disk Electrodes ASTM D 923 Standard Practices for Sampling Electrical Insulating Liquids ASTM D 924 Standard Test Method for Dissipation Factor (or Power Factor) and Relative Permittivity (Dielectric Constant) of Electrical Insulating Liquids ASTM D 971 Standard Test Method for Interfacial Tension of Oil against Water by the Ring Method ASTM D 974 Standard Test Method for Acid and Base Number by Color-Indicator Titration ASTM D 1298 Standard Test Method for Density, Relative Density (Specific Gravity), or API Gravity of Crude Petroleum and Liquid Petroleum Products by Hydrometer Method ASTM D 1500 Standard Test Method for ASTM Color of Petroleum Products (ASTM Color Scale) ASTM D 1524 Standard Test Method for Visual Examination of Used Electrical Insulating Oils of Petroleum Origin in the Field Page 2 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications (continued) ASTM D 1533 Standard Test Methods for Water in Insulating Liquids by Coulometric Karl Fischer Titration ASTM D 1816 Standard Test Method for Dielectric Breakdown Voltage of Insulating Oils of Petroleum Origin Using VDE Electrodes ASTM D 2029 Standard Test Methods for Water Vapor Content of Electrical Insulating Gases by Measurement of Dew Point ASTM D 2129 Standard Test Method for Color of Clear Electrical Insulating Liquids (Platinum-Cobalt Scale) ASTM D 2284 Standard Test Method of Acidity of Sulfur Hexafluoride ASTM D 2285 Standard Test Method for Interfacial Tension of Electrical Insulating Oils of Petroleum Origin against Water by the Drop-Weight Method ASTM D 2477 Standard Test Method for Dielectric Breakdown Voltage and Dielectric Strength of Insulating Gases at Commercial Power Frequencies ASTM D 2685 Standard Test Method for Air and Carbon Tetrafluoride in Sulfur Hexafluoride by Gas Chromatography ASTM D 2759 Standard Practice for Sampling Gas from a Transformer under Positive Pressure ASTM D 3284 Standard Test Method for Combustible Gases in the Gas Space of Electrical Apparatus Using Portable Meters ASTM D 3612 Standard Test Method for Analysis of Gases Dissolved in Electrical Insulating Oil by Gas Chromatography ASTM D 3613 Standard Practice for Sampling Electrical Insulating Oils for Gas Analysis and Determination of Water Content 3. Association of Edison Illuminating Companies – AEIC 4. Canadian Standards Association – CSA Page 3 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications (continued) 5. Electrical Apparatus Service Association – EASA ANSI/EASA AR100 6. Recommended Practice for the Repair of Rotating Electrical Apparatus Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers – IEEE ANSI/IEEE C2 National Electrical Safety Code ANSI/IEEE C37 Compilation Guides and Standards for Circuit Breakers, Switchgear, Relays, Substations, and Fuses ANSI/IEEE C57 Compilation Distribution, Power, and Regulating Transformers ANSI/IEEE C62 Compilation Surge Protection ANSI/IEEE 43 IEEE Recommended Practice for Testing Insulation Resistance of Rotating Machinery ANSI/IEEE 48 IEEE Standard Test Procedures and Requirements for AlternatingCurrent Cable Terminations 2.5 kV through 765 kV IEEE 81 IEEE Guide for Measuring Earth Resistivity, Ground Impedance, and Earth Surface Potentials of a Ground System Part I: Normal Measurements ANSI/IEEE 81.2 IEEE Guide for Measurement of Impedance and Safety Characteristics of Large, Extended or Interconnected Grounding Systems ANSI/IEEE 95 IEEE Recommended Practice for Insulation Testing of Large AC Rotating Machinery with High Direct Voltage IEEE 100 The Authoritative Dictionary of IEEE Standards Terms IEEE 141 IEEE Recommended Practice for Electrical Power Distribution for Industrial Plants (Red Book) ANSI/IEEE 142 IEEE Recommended Practice for Grounding of Industrial and Commercial Power Systems (Green Book) ANSI/IEEE 241 IEEE Recommended Practice for Electric Power Systems in Commercial Buildings (Gray Book) ANSI/IEEE 242 IEEE Recommended Practice for Protection and Coordination of Industrial and Commercial Power Systems (Buff Book) Page 4 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications (continued) IEEE 386 IEEE Standard for Separable Insulated Connectors System for Power Distribution Systems above 600 V ANSI/IEEE 399 IEEE Recommended Practice for Power Systems Analysis (Brown Book) IEEE 400 IEEE Guide for Field Testing and Evaluation of the Insulation of Shielded Power Cable Systems ANSI/IEEE 421.3 IEEE Standard for High-Potential-Test Requirements for Excitation Systems for Synchronous Machines ANSI/IEEE 446 IEEE Recommended Practice for Emergency and Standby Power Systems for Industrial and Commercial Applications (Orange Book) ANSI/IEEE 450 IEEE Recommended Practice for Maintenance, Testing, and Replacement of Vented Lead-Acid Batteries for Stationary Applications ANSI/IEEE 493 IEEE Recommended Practice for the Design of Reliable Industrial and Commercial Power Systems (Gold Book) ANSI/IEEE 519 IEEE Recommended Practices and Requirements for Harmonic Control in Electrical Power Systems ANSI/IEEE 602 IEEE Recommended Practice for Electric Systems in Health Care Facilities (White Book) ANSI/IEEE 637 IEEE Guide for the Reclamation of Insulating Oil and Criteria for Its Use IEEE 644 Procedures for Measurement of Power Frequency Electric and Magnetic Fields from AC Power Lines ANSI/IEEE 739 IEEE Recommended Practice for Energy Management in Commercial and Industrial Facilities (Bronze Book) ANSI/IEEE 902 IEEE Guide for Maintenance, Operation and Safety of Industrial and Commercial Power Systems (Yellow Book) IEEE 1015 IEEE Recommended Practice for Applying Low-Voltage Circuit Breakers Used in Industrial and Commercial Power Systems (Blue Book) IEEE 1100 IEEE Recommended Practice for Powering and Grounding Sensitive Electronic Equipment (Emerald Book) ANSI/IEEE 1106 IEEE Recommended Practice for Maintenance, Testing, and Replacement of Nickel-Cadmium Batteries for Stationary Applications Page 5 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications (continued) 7. 8. ANSI/IEEE 1159 IEEE Recommended Practice on Monitoring Electrical Power Quality ANSI/IEEE 1188 IEEE Recommended Practice for Maintenance, Testing, and Replacement of Valve-Regulated Lead-Acid (VRLA) Batteries for Stationary Applications IEEE 1584 IEEE Guide for Performing Arc-Flash Hazard Calculations IEEE 1584a IEEE Guide for Performing Arc-Flash Hazard Calculations – Amendment 1 Insulated Cable Engineers Association – ICEA ANSI/ICEA S-93-639/NEMA WC 74 5-46 kV Shielded Power Cable for Use in the Transmission and Distribution of Electric Energy ANSI/ICEA S-94-649 Standard for Concentric Neutral Cables Rated 5,000 – 46,000 Volts ANSI/ICEA S-97-682 Standard for Utility Shielded Power Cables Rated 5,000 – 46,000 Volts InterNational Electrical Testing Association – NETA ANSI/NETA ETT Standard for Certification of Electrical Testing Technicians ANSI/NETA ATS Acceptance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems Page 6 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.1 Codes, Standards, and Specifications (continued) 9. National Electrical Manufacturers Association – NEMA NEMA AB4 Guidelines for Inspection and Preventive Maintenance of Molded-Case Circuit Breakers Used in Commercial and Industrial Applications ANSI/NEMA C84.1 Electrical Power Systems and Equipment Voltage Ratings (60 Hz) NEMA MG1 10. Motors and Generators National Fire Protection Association – NFPA ANSI/NFPA 70 National Electrical Code ANSI/NFPA 70B Recommended Practice for Electrical Equipment Maintenance ANSI/NFPA 70E Standard for Electrical Safety in the Workplace ANSI/NFPA 99 Standard for Healthcare Facilities ANSI/NFPA 101 Life Safety Code ANSI/NFPA 110 Emergency and Standby Power Systems ANSI/NFPA 780 Installation of Lightning Protection Systems 11. Occupational Safety and Health Administration – OSHA 12. State and local codes and ordinances 13. Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. – UL Page 7 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.2 Other Publications Manufacturer’s instruction manuals for the equipment to be tested. A Stitch in Time…The Complete Guide to Electrical Insulation Testing, Megger. Electrical Power Equipment Maintenance and Testing, Paul Gill, New York: Taylor & Francis Books. Electrical Safety Handbook, John C. Cadick, New York: McGraw Hill. The Electrical Safety Program Book, Kenneth G. Mastrullo, Ray A. Jones, Jane G. Jones, National Fire Protection Association. Instruction Book PC – 2000 for Wecosol™ Fluid-Filled Primary and Secondary Unit Substation Transformer, ABB Power T&D. 2.3 Contact Information ABB Power T&D Small Transformer Division PO Box 920 South Boston, VA 24592 (434) 572-5695 www.abb.com American National Standards Institute – ANSI 25 West 43rd Street 4th Fl. New York, NY 10036 (212) 642-4900 www.ansi.org ASTM International – ASTM 100 Barr Harbor Drive W. Conshohocken, PA 19428 (610) 832-9585 www.astm.org Association of Edison Illuminating Companies – AEIC 600 N. 18th Street; PO Box 2641 Birmingham, AL 35291 (205) 257-2530 www.aeic.org Canadian Standards Association – CSA 178 Rexdale Boulevard Toronto, ON M9W 1R3 (416) 747-4000 www.csa.ca Page 8 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.3 Contact Information (continued) Electrical Apparatus Service Association – EASA 1331 Baur Boulevard St. Louis, MO 63132 (314) 993-2220 www.easa.com Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers – IEEE PO Box 1331 Piscataway, NJ 08855 (732) 981-0060 www.ieee.org Insulated Cable Engineers Association – ICEA c/o Global Document Engineers 15 Inverness Way East Englewood, CO 80112 (303) 397-7956 www.icea.net International Electrotechnical Commission – IEC Contact through American National Standards Institute InterNational Electrical Testing Association – NETA 3050 Old Centre Ave. Suite 102 Portage, MI 49024 (269)488-6382 or (888) 300-NETA (6382) www.netaworld.org The McGraw-Hill Companies P.O. Box 182604 Columbus, OH 43272 (877) 833-5524 www.mcgraw-hill.com Megger 4271 Bronze Way Dallas, TX 75237 (214) 723-2861 www.megger.com National Electrical Manufacturers Association– NEMA 1300 N. 17th St. Suite 1847 Rosslyn, VA 22209 (703) 841-3200 www.nema.org Page 9 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 2. APPLICABLE REFERENCES 2.3 Contact Information (continued) National Institute of Standards and Technology 100 Bureau Drive Gaithersburg, SD 20899 (301) 975-6478 www.nist.gov National Fire Prevention Association – NFPA 1 Battery March Park PO Box 901 Quincy, MA 02269-9101 (617) 984-7247 www.nfpa.org Occupational Safety and Health Administration – OSHA U.S. Department of Labor Occupational Safety and Health Administration Office of Public Affairs – Room N3647 200 Constitution Avenue Washington, D.C. 20210 (202) 693-1999 www.osha.gov Square D Company, Anderson Product Division P.O. Box 455 Leeds, AL 35094 205-699-2411 www.squared.com Taylor and Francis Books, Inc. – CRC Press 2000 NW Corporate Blvd. Boca Raton, FL 33431 (561) 361-6000 www.crcpress.com Underwriters Laboratories, Inc. – UL 333 Pfingsten Road Northbrook, IL 60062 (847) 272-8800 www.ul.com Page 10 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 3. QUALIFICATIONS OF TESTING PERSONNEL 1. The subjective assessment required by this NETA maintenance standard is unique compared to other American National Standards in that it deals with the evaluation of service-aged equipment. While technicians performing tests and inspections on new equipment deal with finite test values, those working with service-aged equipment must form recommendations based on judgment. 2. Technicians performing these electrical tests and inspections shall be trained and experienced concerning the apparatus and systems being evaluated. These individuals shall be capable of conducting the tests in a safe manner and with complete knowledge of the hazards involved. They must be able to evaluate the test data and make a judgment on the continued serviceability or nonserviceability of the specific equipment. 3. Test technicians shall have knowledge of and experience with the specific device under test. Additional personnel qualifications are as follows: 1. Testing organizations: Owners utilizing testing companies shall require that each onsite crew leader shall hold a current certification, Level III or higher, in electrical testing. This certification shall be in accordance with ANSI/NETA ETT-2010, Standard for Certification of Electrical Testing Personnel. 2. Manufacturers’ Service Personnel: Field service personnel of the manufacturer of the equipment being evaluated shall be certified by the manufacturer to perform these electrical tests and inspections. The manufacturer shall provide sufficient documentation to satisfy the owner that its service personnel are trained and qualified to perform these electrical tests and inspections. 3. In-House Testing Personnel: Owners having in-house testing personnel shall utilize an independent, outside certification organization or have some system of qualification which provides an equivalent level of assurance that their personnel are qualified to perform electrical testing. Owners are encouraged to utilize ANSI/NETA ETT-2010 as a means of determining that their electrical testing personnel possess the training, experience, and proof (examination) requirements now being promulgated by various governmental agencies. Page 11 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 4. DIVISION OF RESPONSIBILITY 4.1 The User The user shall be responsible for all power switching of equipment and for providing equipment in a ready-to-test condition. The user shall provide the testing organization with the following: 1. A short-circuit analysis, a coordination study, an arc-flash hazard analysis, and a protective device setting sheet as described in Section 6, if applicable. 2. The most current set of electrical drawings and instruction manuals applicable to the scope of work relative to the equipment under test. 3. An itemized description of equipment to be inspected and tested. 4. A determination of who shall provide a suitable and stable source of electrical power to each test site. 5. Notification of when equipment becomes available for maintenance tests. Work shall be coordinated to expedite project scheduling. 6. Site-specific hazard notification and safety training. 4.2 The Testing Organization The testing organization shall provide the following: 1. All field technical services, tooling, equipment, instrumentation, and technical supervision to perform such tests and inspections. 2. Specific power requirements for test equipment. 3. Notification to the owner’s representative prior to commencement of any testing. 4. A timely notification of any system, material, or workmanship which is found deficient on the basis of maintenance tests. 5. A record of all tests and a final report. Page 12 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 5. GENERAL 5.1 Safety and Precautions All parties involved must be cognizant of industry-standard safety procedures. This document does not include any procedures, including specific safety procedures. It is recognized that an overwhelming majority of the tests and inspections recommended in these specifications are potentially hazardous. Individuals performing these tests shall be capable of conducting the tests in a safe manner and with complete knowledge of the hazards involved. 1. Safety practices shall include, but are not limited to, the following requirements: 1. All applicable provisions of the Occupational Safety and Health Act, particularly OSHA 29CFR 1910. 2. ANSI/NFPA 70E, Standard for Electrical Safety in the Workplace 3. The Electrical Safety Program Book, Kenneth G. Mastrullo, Ray A. Jones, Jane G. Jones, NFPA. 4. Applicable state and local safety operating procedures. 5. Owner’s safety practices. 2. A safety lead person shall be identified prior to commencement of work. 3. A safety briefing shall be conducted prior to the commencement of work. 4. All tests shall be performed with the apparatus de-energized and grounded except where otherwise specifically required to be ungrounded or energized for certain tests. 5. The testing organization shall have a designated safety representative on the project to supervise operations with respect to safety. This individual may be the same person described in 5.1.2. 5.2 Suitability of Test Equipment 1. All test equipment shall meet the requirements in Section 5.3 and be in good mechanical and electrical condition. 2. Field test metering used to check power system meter calibration must be more accurate than the instrument being tested. 3. Accuracy of metering in test equipment shall be appropriate for the test being performed. 4. Waveshape and frequency of test equipment output waveforms shall be appropriate for the test and the tested equipment. Page 13 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 5. GENERAL 5.3 Test Instrument Calibration 1. The testing organization shall have a calibration program which assures that all applicable test instruments are maintained within rated accuracy for each test instrument calibrated. 2. The firm providing calibration service shall maintain up-to-date instrument calibration instructions and procedures for each test instrument calibrated. 3. The accuracy shall be directly traceable to the National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST). 4. Instruments shall be calibrated in accordance with the following frequency schedule: 1. Field instruments: Analog and digital, 12 months maximum. 2. Laboratory instruments: 12 months maximum. 3. Leased specialty equipment: 12 months maximum. 5. Dated calibration labels shall be visible on all test equipment. 6. Records, which show date and results of instruments calibrated or tested, must be kept up-todate. 7. Calibrating standard shall be of higher accuracy than that of the instrument tested. Page 14 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 5. GENERAL 5.4 Test Report 1. 2. 3. The test report shall include the following: 1. Summary of project. 2. Description of equipment tested. 3. Description of tests. 4. Test data. 5. Analysis and recommendations. Test data records shall include the following minimum requirements: 1. Identification of the testing organization. 2. Equipment identification. 3. Humidity, temperature, and other conditions that may affect the results of the tests/calibrations. 4. Date of inspections, tests, maintenance, and/or calibrations. 5. Identification of the testing technician. 6. Indication of inspections, tests, maintenance, and/or calibrations to be performed and recorded. 7. Indication of expected results when calibrations are to be performed. 8. Indication of “as-found” and “as-left” results, as applicable. 9. Sufficient spaces to allow all results and comments to be indicated. The testing organization shall furnish a copy or copies of the complete report as specified in the maintenance testing contract. Page 15 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.1 Short-Circuit Studies 1. Scope of Study Determine the short-circuit current available at each component of the electrical system and the ability of the component to withstand and/or interrupt the current. Provide an analysis of all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions or changes to the subject system. 2. Procedure The short-circuit study shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE standard 399 and the step-by-step procedures outlined in the short-circuit calculation chapters of IEEE standard 141 and ANSI/IEEE standard 242. 3. Study Report Results of the short-circuit study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the study. 2. Tabulations of the data used to model the system components and a corresponding oneline diagram. 3. Descriptions of the scenarios evaluated and identification of the scenario used to evaluate equipment short-circuit ratings. 4. Tabulations of equipment short-circuit ratings versus available fault duties. The tabulation shall identify percentage of rated short circuit and clearly note equipment with insufficient ratings. 5. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 16 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.2 Coordination Studies 1. Scope of Study 1. 2. 2. Determine the extent of overcurrent protective device coordination for the scope: 1. Selective coordination: determine the protective device types, characteristics, settings, or ampere ratings which provide selective coordination, equipment protection, and correct interrupting ratings for the full range of available shortcircuit currents at points of application for each overcurrent protective device. 2. Compromised coordination: determine protective device types, characteristics, settings, or ampere ratings which permit ranges of non-coordination of overcurrent protective devices. In this case, overcurrent protective device coordination may be compromised due to the overcurrent protective devices selected or already installed or in order to achieve protection of equipment that is selected or already installed. Objective is to maximize coordination of overcurrent protective devices to extent possible based on the type of devices Determine protective device characteristics, settings, or sizes which provide a balance between equipment protection and selective device operation that is optimum for the electrical system. Provide an analysis of all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions or changes to the subject system. Procedure The coordination study shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE standard 399 and ANSI/IEEE standard 242. Protective device selection and settings shall comply with requirements of the National Electrical Code. 3. Study Report Results of the coordination study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the study and a corresponding one-line diagram. 2. Time-current curves, selective coordination ratios of fuses, or selective coordination tables of circuit breakers demonstrating the coordination of overcurrent protective devices to the scope. 3. Tabulations of protective devices identifying circuit location, manufacturer, type, range of adjustment, IEEE device number, current transformer ratios, recommended settings or device size, and referenced time-current curve. Page 17 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.2 Coordination Studies (continued) 4. 4. Conclusions and recommendations. Implementation The owner shall engage an independent testing firm for the purpose of inspecting, setting, testing, and calibrating the protective relays, circuit breakers, fuses, and other applicable devices as outlined in this specification. Page 18 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.3 Arc-Flash Hazard Analysis 1. Scope of Study Determine arc-flash incident energy levels and flash protection boundary distances based on the results of the short-circuit and coordination studies. Perform the analysis under worst-case arcflash conditions for all modes of operation. Provide an analysis of all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions to the subject system. 2. Procedure Identify all locations and equipment to be included in the arc-flash hazard analysis. 3. 1. Prepare a one-line diagram of the power system. 2. Perform a short-circuit study in accordance with Section 6.1. 3. Perform a coordination study in accordance with Section 6.2. 4. Identify the possible system operating modes, including tie-breaker positions, parallel generation, etc. 5. Calculate the arcing fault current flowing through each branch for each fault location using empirical formula in accordance with NFPA, IEEE, or other standards. 6. Determine the time required to clear the arcing fault current using the protective device settings and associated trip curves. 7. Select the working distances based on system voltage and equipment class. 8. Calculate the incident energy at each fault location at the prescribed working distance. 9. Determine the hazard/risk category (HRC) for the estimated incident energy level. 10. Calculate the flash protection boundary at each fault location. 11. Document the assessment in reports and one-line diagrams. 12. Place appropriate labels on the equipment. Study Report Results of the arc-flash study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, method of hazard assessment, description, purpose, scope, and date of the study. Page 19 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.3 Arc-Flash Hazard Analysis (continued) 2. Tabulations of the data used to model the system components and a corresponding oneline diagram. 3. Descriptions of the scenarios evaluated and identification of the scenario used to evaluate equipment ratings. 4. Tabulations of equipment incident energies, hazard risk categories, and flash protection boundaries. The tabulation shall identify and clearly note equipment that exceeds allowable incident energy ratings. 5. Required arc-flash labeling and placement of labels. 6. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 20 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.4 Load-Flow Studies 1. Scope of Study Determine active and reactive power, voltage, current, and power factor throughout the electrical system. Provide an analysis of all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions or changes to the subject system. 2. Procedure The load-flow study shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE standard 399. 3. Study Report Results of the load-flow study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the study. 2. Tabulations of the data used to model the system components and a corresponding oneline diagram. 3. Descriptions of the scenarios evaluated and the basis for each. 4. Tabulations of power and current flow versus equipment ratings. The tabulation shall identify percentage of rated load and the scenario for which the percentage is based. Overloaded equipment shall be clearly noted. 5. Tabulations of system voltages versus equipment ratings. The tabulation shall identify percentage of rated voltage and the scenario for which the percentage is based. Voltage levels outside the ranges recommended by equipment manufacturers, ANSI C84.1, or other appropriate standards shall be clearly noted. 6. Tabulations of system real and reactive power losses with areas of concern clearly noted. 7. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 21 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.5 Stability Studies 1. Scope of Study Determine the ability of the electrical system’s synchronous machines to remain in step with one another following a disturbance. Provide an analysis of disturbances for all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions or changes to the subject system. 2. Procedure The stability study shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE standard 399. 3. Study Report Results of the stability study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the study. 2. Tabulations of the data used to model the system components and a corresponding oneline diagram. 3. Descriptions of the scenarios evaluated and tabulations or graphs showing the calculation results. 4. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 22 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 6. POWER SYSTEM STUDIES 6.6 Harmonic-Analysis Studies 1. Scope of Study Determine the impact of nonlinear loads and their associated harmonic contributions on the voltage and currents throughout the electrical system. Provide an analysis of all possible operating scenarios which will be or have been influenced by the proposed or completed additions or changes to the subject system. 2. Procedure The harmonic-analysis study shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE standard 399. 3. Study Report Results of the harmonic-analysis study shall be summarized in a final report containing the following items: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the study. 2. Tabulations of the data used to model the system components and a corresponding oneline diagram. 3. Descriptions of the scenarios evaluated and the basis for each. 4. Tabulations of rms voltages, peak voltages, rms currents, and total capacitor bank loading versus associated equipment ratings. Equipment with insufficient ratings shall be clearly identified for each of the scenarios evaluated. 5. Tabulations of calculated voltage distortion factors, current distortion factors, and individual harmonics versus the limits specified by IEEE standard 519. Calculated values exceeding the limits specified in the standard shall be clearly noted. 6. Plots of impedance versus frequency showing resonant frequencies to be avoided. 7. Tabulations of the system transformer capabilities based on the calculated nonsinusoidal load current and the procedures set forth in ANSI/IEEE C57.110. Overloaded transformers shall be clearly noted. 8. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 23 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical, electrical, and mechanical condition including evidence of moisture or corona. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required area clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Verify that fuse and/or circuit breaker sizes and types correspond to drawings and coordination study as well as to the circuit breaker’s address for microprocessor-communication packages. 6. Verify that current and voltage transformer ratios correspond to drawings. 7. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 8. 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Confirm correct operation and sequencing of electrical and mechanical interlock systems. 1. Attempt closure on locked-open devices. Attempt to open locked-closed devices. 2. Make key exchange with all devices included in the interlock scheme as applicable. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 10. Verify correct barrier and shutter installation and operation. 11. Exercise all active components. 12. Inspect mechanical indicating devices for correct operation. 13. Verify that filters are in place and/or vents are clear. 14. Perform visual and mechanical inspection of instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 24 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies (continued) 15. 16. 2. Inspect control power transformers. 1. Inspect for physical damage, cracked insulation, broken leads, tightness of connections, defective wiring, and overall general condition. 2. Verify that primary and secondary fuse ratings or circuit breakers match drawings. 3. Verify correct functioning of drawout disconnecting and grounding contacts and interlocks. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted electrical connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.1.1, if applicable. 2. Perform insulation–resistance tests for one minute on each bus section, phase-to-phase and phase-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *3. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each bus section, each phase-to-ground with phases not under test grounded, in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer has no recommendation for this test, it shall be in accordance with Table 100.2. The test voltage shall be applied for one minute. Refer to Section 7.1.3 before performing test. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 5. Perform electrical tests on instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. 6. Perform ground–resistance tests in accordance with Section 7.13. 7. Determine accuracy of all meters and calibrate watthour meters in accordance with Section 7.11. 8. Control Power Transformers 1. Perform insulation-resistance tests. Perform measurements from winding-to-winding and each winding-to-ground. Test voltages shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. * Optional Page 25 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies (continued) 2. 9. 10. Verify correct function of control transfer relays located in switchgear with multiple power sources. Verify operation of switchgear/switchboard heaters and their controller, if applicable. Perform system function tests in accordance with Section 8. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.1.1.7.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.1.1.7.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.1.1.7.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of bus insulation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the test, the test dielectric withstand voltage specimen is considered to have passed the test. 4. Minimum insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Results of electrical tests on instrument transformers should be in accordance with Section 7.10. 6. Results of ground resistance tests should be in accordance with Section 7.13. 7. Accuracy of meters should be in accordance with Section 7.11. * Optional Page 26 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.1 Switchgear and Switchboard Assemblies (continued) 8. 9. 10. Control Power Transformers 1. Insulation-resistance values of control power transformers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 2. Control transfer relays should perform as designed. Heaters should be operational. Results of system function tests shall be in accordance with Section 8. * Optional Page 27 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.1 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Low-Voltage, Small NOTE: This category consists of power transformers with windings rated 600 volts or less and sizes equal to or less than 167 kVA single-phase or 500 kVA three-phase. 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection. 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use a of low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.2.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 6. Perform as-left tests. 7. Verify that as-left tap connections are as specified. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.2.1.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests winding-to-winding and each winding-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Calculate the dielectric absorption ratio or polarization index. *3. Perform turns-ratio tests at the designated tap position. * Optional Page 28 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.1 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Low-Voltage, Small (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.2.1.1.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.2.1.1.1.5.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.2.1.1.1.5.3) 4. Tap connections are left as found unless otherwise specified. (7.2.1.1.7) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted electrical connection resistances to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Minimum insulation-resistance values of transformer insulation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. The dielectric absorption ratio or polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. 3. Turns-ratio test results should not deviate more than one-half percent from either the adjacent coils or the calculated ratio. * Optional Page 29 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.2 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Large NOTE: This category consists of power transformers with windings rated higher than 600 volts and low-voltage transformers larger than 167 kVA single-phase or 500 kVA three-phase. 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition including evidence of moisture and corona. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. *5. Verify that control and alarm settings on temperature indicators are as specified. 6. Verify that cooling fans operate correctly. 7. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.2.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 8. Perform specific inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. 9. Perform as-left tests. 10. Verify that as-left tap connections are as specified. 11. Verify the presence of surge arresters. * Optional Page 30 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.2 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Large (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.2.1.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests winding-to-winding and each winding-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Calculate polarization index. 3. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on all windings in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. *4. Perform a power-factor or dissipation-factor tip-up test on windings rated greater than 2.5 kV. 5. Perform turns-ratio tests at the designated tap position. 6. Perform an excitation-current test on each phase. *7. 8. Measure the resistance of each winding at the designated tap position. Measure core insulation resistance at 500 volts dc if the core is insulated and if the core ground strap is removable. *9. Perform an applied voltage test on all high- and low-voltage windings-to-ground. See ANSI/IEEE C57.12.91, Sections 10.2 and 10.9. 10. Verify correct secondary voltage phase-to-phase and phase-to-neutral after energization and prior to loading. 11. Test surge arresters in accordance with Section 7.19. * Optional Page 31 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.2 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Large (continued) 3.1 3.2 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Control and alarm settings on temperature indicators should operate within manufacturer’s recommendations for specified settings. (7.2.1.2.1.5) 2. Cooling fans should operate. (7.2.1.2.1.6) 3. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.2.1.2.1.7.1) 4. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.2.1.2.1.7.2) 5. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.2.1.2.1.7.3) 6. Tap connections shall be left as found unless otherwise specified. (7.2.1.2.1.10) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Minimum insulation-resistance values of transformer insulation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. The polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. 3. CH and CL power-factor or dissipation-factor values will vary due to support insulators and bus work utilized on dry transformers. The following should be expected on CHL power factors: Power transformers: 2.0 percent or less Distribution transformers: 5.0 percent or less Consult transformer manufacturer’s or test equipment manufacturer’s data for additional information. 4. Power-factor or dissipation-factor tip-up exceeding 1.0 percent should be investigated. 5. Turns-ratio test results should not deviate more than one-half percent from either the adjacent coils or the calculated ratio. 6. The typical excitation current test data pattern for a three-legged core transformer is two similar current readings and one lower current reading. * Optional Page 32 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.1.2 Transformers, Dry Type, Air-Cooled, Large (continued) 7. Temperature-corrected winding-resistance values should compare within one percent of previously-obtained results. 8. Core insulation-resistance values should be comparable to previously-obtained results but not less than one megohm at 500 volts dc. 9. AC dielectric withstand test voltage shall not exceed 65 percent of factory test voltage for one minute duration. DC dielectric withstand test voltage shall not exceed 100 percent of the ac rms test voltage specified in ANSI C57.12.91, Section 10.2 for one minute duration. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 10. Phase-to-phase and phase-to-neutral secondary voltages should be in agreement with nameplate data. 11. Test results for surge arresters shall be in accordance with Section 7.19. * Optional Page 33 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.2 Transformers, Liquid-Filled 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify the presence of PCB labeling, if applicable. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean bushings and control cabinets. *6. 7. Verify that cooling fans and/or pumps operate correctly. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 2. Verify operation of alarm, control, and trip circuits from temperature and level indicators, pressure relief device, and fault pressure relay, if applicable. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.2.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify correct liquid level in tanks and bushings. 10. Verify that positive pressure is maintained on gas-blanketed transformers. 11. Perform inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. 12. Test load tap-changer in accordance with Section 7.12, if applicable. 13. Verify the presence of transformer surge arresters. 14. Perform as-left tests. 15. Verify de-energized tap-changer position is left as specified. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.2.2.1. * Optional Page 34 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.2 Transformers, Liquid-Filled (continued) 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests, winding-to-winding and each winding-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Calculate polarization index. 3. Perform turns-ratio tests at the designated tap position. 4. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on all windings in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 5. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing. 6. Perform excitation-current tests in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 7. Measure the resistance of each winding at the designated tap position. *8. If the core ground strap is accessible, remove and measure the core insulation resistance at 500 volts dc. *9. Measure the percentage of oxygen in the gas blanket, if applicable. 10. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 923. The sample shall be tested for the following. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 and/or ASTM D 1816 2. Acid neutralization number: ANSI/ASTM D 974 *3. Specific gravity: ANSI/ASTM D 1298 4. Interfacial tension: ANSI/ASTM D 971 or ANSI/ASTM D 2285 5. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 6. Visual Condition: ASTM D 1524 *7. Water in insulating liquids: ASTM D 1533. (Required on 25 kV or higher voltages and on all silicone-filled units.) *8. Measure power factor or dissipation factor in accordance with ASTM D 924. 11. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 3613 and perform dissolved-gas analysis (DGA) in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D3612. 12. Test the instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 35 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.2 Transformers, Liquid-Filled (continued) 13. Test the surge arresters in accordance with Section 7.19. 14. Test the transformer neutral grounding impedance devices, if applicable. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Alarm, control, and trip circuits from temperature and level indicators as well as pressure relief device and fault pressure relay should operate within manufacturer’s recommendations for their specified settings. (7.2.2.1.6) 2. Cooling fans and/or pumps should operate. (7.2.2.1.7) 3. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.2.2.1.8.1) 4. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.2.2.1.8.2) 5. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.2.2.1.8.3) 6. Liquid levels in the transformer tanks and bushings should be within indicated tolerances. (7.2.2.1.9) 7. Positive pressure should be indicated on pressure gauge for gas-blanketed transformers. (7.2.2.1.10) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Minimum insulation-resistance values of transformer insulation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. The polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. 3. Turns-ratio test results should not deviate by more than one-half percent from either the adjacent coils or the calculated ratio. * Optional Page 36 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.2.2 Transformers, Liquid-Filled (continued) 4. Maximum power-factor/dissipation-factor values of liquid-filled transformers corrected to 20° C should be in accordance with the transformer manufacturer’s published data. Representative values are indicated in Table 100.3. 5. Investigate bushing power-factor and capacitance values that vary from nameplate values by more than ten percent. Hot-collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 6. Typical excitation-current test data pattern for a three-legged core transformer is two similar current readings and one lower current reading. 7. Temperature corrected winding-resistance values should compare within one percent of previously obtained results. 8. Core insulation values should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than one megohm at 500 volts dc. 9. Investigate the presence of oxygen in the nitrogen gas blanket. 10. Insulating liquid values should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 11. Evaluate results of dissolved-gas analysis in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard C57.104. 12. Results of electrical tests on instrument transformers shall be in accordance with Section 7.10. 13. Results of surge arrester tests shall be in accordance with Section 7.19. 14. Compare grounding impedance device values to previously obtained results. In the absence of previously obtained values, compare obtained values to manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 37 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.1 Cables, Low-Voltage, Low-Energy – RESERVED – * Optional Page 38 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.2 Cables, Low-Voltage, 600-Volt Maximum 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect exposed sections of cables for physical damage and evidence of overheating. 2. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 3. 2. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.3.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Inspect compression-applied connectors for correct cable match and indentation. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.3.2.1. 2. Perform an insulation-resistance test on each conductor with respect to ground and adjacent conductors. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. The test duration shall be one minute. 3. Verify uniform resistance of parallel conductors. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.3.2.1.2.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.3.2.1.2.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.3.2.1.2.3) * Optional Page 39 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.2 Cables, Low-Voltage, 600-Volt Maximum (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be comparable to previously obtained results and similar circuits but not less than two megohms. 3. Deviations in resistance between parallel conductors shall be investigated. * Optional Page 40 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.3 Cables, Medium- and High-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect exposed sections of cables for physical damage and evidence of overheating and corona. 2. Inspect terminations and splices for physical damage, evidence of overheating, and corona. 3. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.3.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 4. Inspect compression-applied connectors for correct cable match and indentation. 5. Inspect shield grounding and cable support. 6. Verify that visible cable bends meet or exceed ICEA and/or manufacturer’s minimum allowable bending radius. *7. 8. 2. 1. Inspect fireproofing in common cable areas. If cables are terminated through window-type current transformers, inspect to verify that neutral and ground conductors are correctly placed and that shields are correctly terminated for operation of protective devices. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.3.3.1. 2. Perform an insulation-resistance test individually on each conductor with all other conductors and shields grounded. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a shield-continuity test on each power cable by ohmmeter method. * Optional Page 41 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.3 Cables, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) Due to the various cable testing methods commercially available, the following section does not denote “optional” or “required” tests. It is only after careful analysis of all circuit parameters between the testing entity and the cable owner that a preferred testing method should be selected. 4. In accordance with ICEA, IEC, IEEE and other power cable consensus standards, testing can be performed by means of direct current, power frequency alternating current, or very low frequency alternating current. These sources may be used to perform insulation withstand tests, and diagnostic tests such as partial discharge analysis, and power factor or dissipation factor. The selection can only be made after an evaluation of the available test methods and a review of the installed cable system. 4.1 4.2 Dielectric Withstand 1. Direct current (DC) dielectric withstand voltage 2. Very low frequency (VLF) dielectric withstand voltage 3. Power frequency (50/60 Hz) dielectric withstand voltage Diagnostic Tests 1. Power factor/dissipation factor (tan delta) 1. Power frequency (50/60 Hz) 2. Very low frequency (VLF) 2. DC insulation resistance 3. Partial discharge 1. On line (50/60 Hz) 2. Off line 1. Power frequency (50/60 Hz) 2. Very low frequency (VLF) * Optional Page 42 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.3.3 Cables, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) 3 Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.3.3.1.3.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.3.3.1.3.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.3.3.1.3.3) 4. The minimum bend radius to which insulated cables may be bent for permanent training shall be in accordance with Table 100.22. (7.3.3.1.6) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1.Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Shielding shall exhibit continuity. Investigate resistance values in excess of ten ohms per 1000 feet of cable. 4.1 If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 4.2 Based on the test methodology chosen, refer to applicable standards or manufacturer’s literature for acceptable values. * Optional Page 43 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.4 Metal-Enclosed Busways 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.4.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections and bus joints by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 4. Confirm physical orientation in accordance with manufacturer’s labels to insure adequate cooling. 5. Examine outdoor busway for removal of “weep-hole” plugs, if applicable, and for the correct installation of joint shield. 6. Inspect and clean ventilating openings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections and bus joints with a lowresistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.4.1. 2. Perform insulation resistance tests on each busway for one minute, phase-to-phase and phaseto-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each busway, phase-to-ground with phases not under test grounded, in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer has no recommendation for this test, it shall be in accordance with Table 100.17. Where no dc test value is shown in Table 100.17, ac value shall be used. The test voltage shall be applied for one minute. *4. Perform a contact-resistance test on each connection point of uninsulated busway. On insulated busway, measure resistance of assembled busway sections and compare values with the adjacent phases. 5. Verify operation of busway space heaters. * Optional Page 44 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.4 Metal-Enclosed Busways (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.4.1.3.1) 2 Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.4.1.3.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.4.1.3.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance test voltages and resistance values shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s specifications or Table 100.1. Minimum resistance values are for a nominal 1000-foot busway run. Use the following formula to convert the measured resistance value to the 1000-foot nominal value: R1000 ft = Measured Resistance x Length of Run 1000 Converted values of insulation resistance less than those in Table 100.1 or manufacturer’s minimum should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests shall not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 4. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values which deviate from those of similar bus connections and sections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 5. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 45 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.1 Switches, Air, Low-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Verify correct blade alignment, blade penetration, travel stops, and mechanical operation. 6. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit study, and coordination study. 7. Verify that each fuse has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify operation and sequencing of interlocking systems. 10. Verify phase-barrier mounting is intact. 11. Verify correct operation of indicating and control devices. 12. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 13. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 46 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.1 Switches, Air, Low-Voltage (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.5.1.1.1. 2. Measure contact resistance across each switchblade and fuseholder. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 4. Measure fuse resistance. 5. Verify cubicle space heater operation. 6. Perform a ground-fault test in accordance with Section 7.14, if applicable. 7. Perform tests on other protective devices in accordance with Section 7.9, if applicable. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.1.1.1.8.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.1.1.1.8.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.1.1.1.8.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. * Optional Page 47 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.1 Switches, Air, Low-Voltage (continued) 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 4. Investigate fuse-resistance values that deviate from each other by more than 15 percent. 5. Heaters should be operational. 6. Ground fault tests should be in accordance with Section 7.14. 7. Results of protective device tests should be in accordance with Section 7.9. * Optional Page 48 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.2 Switches, Air, Medium-Voltage, Metal-Enclosed 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Verify correct blade alignment, blade penetration, travel stops, arc interrupter operation, and mechanical operation. 6. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit studies, and coordination study. 7. Verify that expulsion-limiting devices are in place on all fuses having expulsion-type elements. 8. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity. 9. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 10. Verify operation and sequencing of interlocking systems. 11. Verify that phase-barrier mounting is intact. 12. Verify correct operation of all indicating and control devices. 13. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 14. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 49 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.2 Switches, Air, Medium-Voltage, Metal-Enclosed (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.5.1.2.1. 2. Measure contact resistance across each switchblade assembly and fuseholder. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 4. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each pole with switch closed. Test each pole-toground with all other poles grounded. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.2. 5. Measure fuse resistance. 6. Verify cubicle space heater operation. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.1.2.1.9.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.1.2.1.9.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.1.2.1.9.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. * Optional Page 50 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.2 Switches, Air, Medium-Voltage, Metal-Enclosed (continued) 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests shall not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 5. Investigate fuse resistance values that deviate from each other by more than 15 percent. 6. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 51 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.3 Switches, Air, Medium- and High-Voltage, Open 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning insulators, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the insulators. 5. Verify correct blade alignment, blade penetration, travel stops, arc interrupter operation, and mechanical operation. 6. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit studies, and coordination study. 7. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.1.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify operation and sequencing of interlocking systems. 10. Perform mechanical operator tests in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, if applicable. 11. Verify correct operation and adjustment of motor operator limit switches and mechanical interlocks, if applicable. 12. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 13. Perform as-left tests. 14. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. * Optional Page 52 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.3 Switches, Air, Medium- and High-Voltage, Open (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.5.1.3.1. 2. Perform a contact-resistance test across each switchblade and fuseholder. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *4. 5. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each pole with switch closed. Test each pole-toground with all other poles grounded. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.19. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.1.3.1.8.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.1.3.1.8.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.1.3.1.8.3) 4. Operation counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.5.1.3.1.14) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, * Optional Page 53 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.1.3 Switches, Air, Medium- and High-Voltage, Open (continued) investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. Minimum insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. * Optional Page 54 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.2 Switches, Oil, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform mechanical operator tests in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, if applicable. 6. Verify correct operation and adjustment of motor operator limit switches and mechanical interlocks, if applicable. *7. Verify correct blade alignment, blade penetration, travel stops, arc interrupter operation, and mechanical operation. 8. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity, if applicable. 9. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short circuit studies, and coordination study. 10. Test all electrical and mechanical interlock systems for correct operation and sequencing. 11. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 12. Verify that insulating oil level is correct. 13. Inspect and/or replace gaskets as recommended by the manufacturer. 14. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. * Optional Page 55 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.2 Switches, Oil, Medium-Voltage (continued) 2. 15. Perform as-left tests. 16. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings, if applicable. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.5.2.1. 2. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with the switch closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. *5. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each pole with switch closed. Test each pole-toground with all other poles grounded. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.19. *6 Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.2.1.11.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.2.1.11.2) * Optional Page 56 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.2 Switches, Oil, Medium-Voltage (continued) 3.2 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.2.1.11.3) 4. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.5.2.1.16) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 6. Insulating liquid test results should be in accordance with Table 100.4. * Optional Page 57 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.3 Switches, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform mechanical operator tests in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, if applicable. 6. Verify correct operation and adjustment of motor operator limit switches and mechanical interlocks, if applicable. 7. Measure critical distances on operating mechanism as recommended by the manufacturer. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter. See Section 7.5.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Inspect insulating assemblies for evidence of physical damage or contaminated surfaces. 10. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate support and contact integrity. 11. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit studies, and coordination study. 12. Test all electrical and mechanical interlock systems for correct operation and sequencing. 13. Verify that insulating oil level is correct, if applicable. 14. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 15. Perform as-left tests. 16. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings, if applicable. * Optional Page 58 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.3 Switches, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted electrical connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable. See Section 7.5.3.1. 2. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 4. Perform a vacuum bottle integrity (dielectric withstand voltage) test across each vacuum bottle with the switch in the open position in strict accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 5. Remove a sample of insulating liquid, if applicable, in accordance with ASTM D 923. The sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 2. Color: ASTM D 1500 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 *6. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow the manufacturer’s recommendation. *7. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Verify open and close operation from control devices, if applicable. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Critical distances of operating mechanism should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.5.3.1.7) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.3.1.8.1) * Optional Page 59 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.3 Switches, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage (continued) 3.2 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.3.1.8.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.3.1.8.3) 5. Operation counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.5.3.1.16) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the vacuum bottle integrity test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 5. Insulating liquid test results should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 6. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 7. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 8. Results of open and close operation from control devices should be in accordance with system design. * Optional Page 60 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.4 Switches, SF6, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if applicable. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect and service mechanical operator and SF6 gas insulated system in accordance with the manufacturer’s published data. 6. Verify correct operation of SF6 gas pressure alarms and limit switches, if applicable, as recommended by the manufacturer. 7. Measure critical distances as recommended by the manufacturer. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.4.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify that fuse sizes and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit studies, and coordination study. 10. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity. 11. Verify operation and sequencing of interlocking systems. 12. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 13. Test for SF6 gas leaks in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 14. Perform as-left tests. 15. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings, if applicable. * Optional Page 61 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.4 Switches, SF6, Medium-Voltage (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through accessible bolted electrical connections with a lowresistance ohmmeter, if applicable. See Section 7.5.4.1. 2. Perform a contact-resistance test. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *4. Remove a sample of SF6 gas and test in accordance with Table 100.13. 5. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test across each gas bottle with the switch in the open position in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. *6. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. *7. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Verify open and close operation from control devices, if applicable. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Critical distances of operating mechanism should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.5.4.1.7) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.4.1.8.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.4.1.8.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.4.1.8.3) 5. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.5.4.1.15) * Optional Page 62 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.4 Switches, SF6, Medium-Voltage (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. Results of SF6 gas tests should be in accordance with Table 100.13. 5. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 6. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 7. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 8. Results of open and close operation from control devices should be in accordance with system design. * Optional Page 63 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.5 Switches, Cutouts 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding, if applicable. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.5.5.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 6. Verify correct blade alignment, blade penetration, travel stops, latching mechanism, and mechanical operation. 7. Verify that fuse size and types are in accordance with drawings, short-circuit study, and coordination study. 8. Verify that each fuseholder has adequate mechanical support and contact integrity. 9. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.5.5.1. 2. Measure contact resistance across each cutout. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with switch closed and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 4. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each pole, phase to ground with cutout closed. Ground adjacent cutouts, if applicable. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. * Optional Page 64 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.5.5 Switches, Cutouts (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.5.5.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.5.5.1.5.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.5.5.1.5.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values which deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 4. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. * Optional Page 65 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.1 Circuit Breakers, Air, Insulated-Case/Molded-Case 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage and alignment. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Operate the circuit breaker to insure smooth operation. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 7. Inspect operating mechanism, contacts, and arc chutes in unsealed units. 8. Perform adjustments for final protective device settings in accordance with coordination study provided by end user. 9. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.6.1.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with the circuit breaker closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. * Optional Page 66 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.1 Circuit Breakers, Air, Insulated-Case/Molded-Case (continued) *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 5. Determine long-time pickup and delay by primary current injection. 6. Determine short-time pickup and delay by primary current injection. 7. Determine ground-fault pickup delay by primary current injection. 8. Determine instantaneous pickup current by primary injection. *9. Test functions of the trip unit by means of secondary injection. 10. Perform minimum pickup voltage test on shunt trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. 11. Verify correct operation of auxiliary features such as trip and pickup indicators, zone interlocking, electrical close and trip operation, trip-free, antipump function, and trip unit battery condition. 12. Reset all trip logs and indicators. 13. Verify operation of charging mechanism. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.1.1.1.6.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.1.1.1.6.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.1.1.1.6.3) 4. Settings shall comply with coordination study recommendations. (7.6.1.1.1.8) * Optional Page 67 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.1 Circuit Breakers, Air, Insulated-Case/Molded-Case (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Long-time pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic should not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current characteristic tolerance band, including adjustment factors. If manufacturer’s curves are not available, trip times should not exceed the value shown in Table 100.7. 6. Short-time pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic should not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current tolerance band. 7. Ground fault pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic should not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current tolerance band. 8. Instantaneous pickup values of molded-case circuit breakers should fall within manufacturer’s published tolerances and/or Table 100.8. 9. Pickup values and trip characteristics should be within manufacturer’s published tolerances. 10. Minimum pickup voltage on shunt trip and close coils should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to Table 100.20. 11. Breaker open, close, trip, trip-free, antipump, and auxiliary features should function as designed. 12. Trip logs and indicators are reset. 13. The charging mechanism should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 68 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.2 Circuit Breakers, Air, Low-Voltage Power 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify that all maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the breaker. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Inspect arc chutes. 7. Inspect moving and stationary contacts for condition, wear, and alignment. 8. Verify that primary and secondary contact wipe and other dimensions vital to satisfactory operation of the breaker are correct. 9. Perform all mechanical operator and contact alignment tests on both the breaker and its operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 11. Verify cell fit and element alignment. 12. Verify racking mechanism operation. 13. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 14. Perform adjustments for final protective device settings in accordance with coordination study provided by end user. 15. Perform as-left tests. 16. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings, if applicable. * Optional Page 69 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.2 Circuit Breakers, Air, Low-Voltage Power (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.6.1.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with the circuit breaker closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 5. Determine long-time pickup and delay by primary current injection. 6. Determine short-time pickup and delay by primary current injection. 7. Determine ground-fault pickup and delay by primary current injection. 8. Determine instantaneous pickup current by primary current injection. *9. Test functions of the trip unit by means of secondary injection. 10. Perform minimum pickup voltage test on shunt trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. 11. Verify correct operation of auxiliary features such as trip and pickup indicators, zone interlocking, electrical close and trip operation, trip-free, antipump function, and trip unit battery condition. 12. Reset all trip logs and indicators. 13. Verify operation of charging mechanism. * Optional Page 70 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.2 Circuit Breakers, Air, Low-Voltage Power (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.1.2.1.10.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.1.2.1.10.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.1.2.1.10.3) 4. Settings shall comply with coordination study recommendations. (7.6.1.2.1.15) 5. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.6.1.2.1.16) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of breakers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Long-time pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic shall not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current characteristic tolerance band. 6. Short-time pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic should not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current tolerance band. 7. Ground fault pickup values should be as specified, and the trip characteristic should not exceed manufacturer’s published time-current tolerance band. 8. Instantaneous pickup values should be within the tolerances of manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 71 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.2 Circuit Breakers, Air, Low-Voltage Power (continued) 9. Pickup values and trip characteristic should be as specified and within manufacturer’s published tolerances. 10. Minimum pickup voltage on shunt trip and close coils should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to Table 100.20. 11. Auxiliary features should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 12. Trip logs and indicators are reset. 13. The charging mechanism should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 72 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.3 Circuit Breakers, Air, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify that all maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the breaker. *4. Perform operator analysis (first-trip) test. 5. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 6. Clean the unit. 7. Inspect arc chutes. 8. Inspect moving and stationary contacts for condition, wear, and alignment. 9. If recommended by manufacturer, slow close/open breaker and check for binding, friction, contact alignment, contact sequence, and penetration. Verify that contact sequence is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to ANSI/IEEE C37.04. 10. Perform all mechanical operation tests on the operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 11. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.1.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 12. Verify cell fit and element alignment. 13. Verify racking mechanism operation. 14. Inspect puffer operation. 15. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. * Optional Page 73 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.3 Circuit Breakers, Air, Medium-Voltage (continued) *16. 2. Perform time-travel analysis. 17. Perform as-left tests. 18. Record as-found and as-left operation-counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable. See Section 7.6.1.3.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with the circuit breaker closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 4. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 5. With the breaker in a test position, perform the following tests: 1. Trip and close breaker with the control switch. 2. Trip breaker by operating each of its protective relays. 3. Verify mechanism charge, trip-free, and antipump functions. *6. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. *7. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests with breaker in both the open and closed positions. *8. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. *9. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each phase with the circuit breaker closed and the poles not under test grounded. Test voltage should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.19. * Optional Page 74 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.3 Circuit Breakers, Air, Medium-Voltage (continued) 10. Verify blowout coil circuit continuity. 11. Verify operation of cubicle space heaters, if applicable. *12. Test instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare first-trip operation time and trip-coil current waveform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, compare first-trip operation time and tripcoil current waveform to previously obtained results. (7.6.1.3.1.4) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.1.3.1.11.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.1.3.1.11.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.1.3.1.11.3) 5. Compare travel and velocity values to manufacturer’s published data and previous test data. (7.6.1.3.1.16) 6. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.6.1.2.1.18) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of circuit breakers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 4. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values shall not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, * Optional Page 75 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.1.3 Circuit Breakers, Air, Medium-Voltage (continued) investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 5. Breaker mechanism charge, close, open, trip, trip-free, and antipump features shall function as designed. 6. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, refer to Table 100.20. 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be compared with previous test results of similar breakers or manufacturer’s published data. 8. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 9. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the circuit breaker is considered to have passed the test. 10. The blowout coil circuit should exhibit continuity. 11. Cubicle space heaters should be operational. 12. The results of instrument transformer tests shall be in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 76 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify that maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the breaker. *4. Perform operator analysis (first-trip) test. 5. Verify correct oil level in tanks and bushings. 6. Verify that breather vents are clear. 7. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 8. Clean the unit. 9. Inspect and service hydraulic or pneumatic system and/or air compressor in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Test alarms, pressure switches, and limit switches for pneumatic and/or hydraulic operators as recommended by the manufacturer. 11. Perform all mechanical operation tests on the operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. *12. If performing internal inspection: 1. Remove oil. Lower tanks or remove manhole covers as necessary. Inspect bottom of tank for broken parts and debris and clean carbon residue from tank. 2. Inspect lift rod and toggle assemblies, contacts, interrupters, bumpers, dashpots, bushing current transformers, tank liners, and gaskets. 3. If recommended by manufacturer, slow close/open breaker and check for binding, friction, contact alignment, and penetration. Verify that contact sequence is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to ANSI C37.04. 4. Refill tank(s) with filtered oil to correct levels. * Optional Page 77 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) 13. 2. Inspect all bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.2.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 14. Verify cell fit and element alignment, if applicable. 15. Verify racking mechanism operation, if applicable. 16. Perform time-travel analysis. 17. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 18. Perform as-left tests. 19. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.6.2.1.12.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with circuit breaker closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or for control devices that cannot tolerate the voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. * Optional Page 78 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) 5. 6. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 923. The sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 *3. Power factor: ASTM D 924 *4. Interfacial tension: ANSI/ASTM D 971 or ANSI/ASTM D 2285 *5. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 With breaker in a test position, make the following tests: 1. Trip and close breaker with the control switch. 2. Trip breaker by operating each of its protective relays. 3. Verify trip-free and antipump functions. *4. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. 7. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each pole with the breaker open and each phase with the breaker closed. Determine tank loss index. 8. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. *9. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each phase with the circuit breaker closed and the poles not under test grounded. Test voltage should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.19. 10. Verify operation of heaters. *11. Test instrument transformers in accordance Section 7.10. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare first-trip operation time and trip-coil current waveform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, compare first-trip operation time and tripcoil current waveform to previously obtained results. (7.6.2.1.4) * Optional Page 79 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) 3.2 2. Settings for alarm, pressure, and limit switches should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.6.2.1.10) 3. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.2.1.13.1) 4. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.2.1.13.2) 5. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.2.1.13.3) 6. Compare travel and velocity values to manufacturer’s published data and previous test data. (7.6.2.1.16) 7. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.6.2.1.19) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of circuit breakers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Insulating liquid test results should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 6. Open, close, trip-free, and antipump features should function in accordance with manufacturer’s design. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils should conform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to Table 100.20. * Optional Page 80 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.2 Circuit Breakers, Oil, Medium- and High-Voltage (continued) 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values and tank loss index shall be compared to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, the comparison shall be made to test data from similar breakers or data from test equipment manufacturers. 8. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 9. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 10. Heaters should be operational. 11. Results of electrical tests on instrument transformers should be in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 81 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.3 Circuit Breakers, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify that all maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the breaker. *4. Perform operator analysis (first-trip) test. 5. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 6. Clean the unit. 7. Inspect vacuum bottle assemblies. 8. Measure critical distances such as contact gap as recommended by the manufacturer. 9. If recommended by the manufacturer, slow close/open the breaker and check for binding, friction, contact alignment, contact sequence, and penetration. 10. Perform all mechanical operation tests on the operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 11. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.3.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 12. Verify cell fit and element alignment. 13. Verify racking mechanism operation. 14. Inspect vacuum bellows operation. 15. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. * Optional Page 82 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.3 Circuit Breakers, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage (continued) *16. 2. Perform time-travel analysis. 17. Perform as-left tests. 18. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.6.3.1.10. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with circuit breaker closed and across each pole with the breaker open. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 4. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 5. With breaker in a test position, perform the following tests: 1. Trip and close breaker with the control switch. 2. Trip breaker by operating each of its protective relays. 3. Verify mechanism charge, trip-free, and antipump functions. *6. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. *7. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each pole with the breaker open and each phase with the breaker closed. *8. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 9. Perform a vacuum bottle integrity (dielectric withstand voltage) test across each vacuum bottle with the breaker in the open position in strict accordance with manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 83 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.3 Circuit Breakers, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage (continued) *10. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on each phase with the circuit breaker closed and the poles not under test grounded. Test voltage should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.19. 11. Verify operation of heaters, if applicable. 12. Test instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare first-trip operation time and trip-coil current waveform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, compare first-trip operation time and tripcoil current waveform to previously obtained results. (7.6.3.1.4) 2. Mechanical operation and contact alignment should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.6.3.1.9) 3. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.3.1.11.1) 4. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.3.1.11.2) 5. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.3.1.11.3) 6. Compare travel and velocity values to manufacturer’s published data and previous test data. (7.6.3.1.16) 7. Operation counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.6.3.1.18) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of circuit breakers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. * Optional Page 84 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.3 Circuit Breakers, Vacuum, Medium-Voltage (continued) 3. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 4. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values shall not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 5. Breaker mechanism charge, close, open, trip, trip-free, and antipump features shall function as designed. 6. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, refer to Table 100.20. 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be compared to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data the comparison shall be made to similar breakers. 8. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 9. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the vacuum bottle integrity test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 10. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 11. Heaters should be operational. 12. Results of instrument transformer tests shall be in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 85 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.4 Circuit Breakers, SF6 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Verify that all maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the breaker. *4. Perform operator analysis (first-trip) test. 5. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 6. Clean the unit. *7. When provisions are made for sampling, remove a sample of SF6 gas and test in accordance with Table 100.13. Do not break seal or distort sealed-for-life interrupters. 8. Inspect and service operating mechanism and/or hydraulic or pneumatic system and SF6 gasinsulated system in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 9. Test for SF6 gas leaks in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Test alarms, pressure switches, and limit switches for pneumatic and/or hydraulic operators and SF6 gas pressure in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 11. If recommended by manufacturer, slow close/open breaker and check for binding, friction, contact alignment, and penetration. Verify that contact sequence is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to ANSI/IEEE C37.04. 12. Perform all mechanical operation tests on the operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 13. Inspect all bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 14. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.6.4.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify cell fit and element alignment. * Optional Page 86 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.4 Circuit Breakers, SF6 (continued) 2. 15. Verify racking mechanism operation. 16. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 17. Perform time-travel analysis. 18. Perform as-left tests. 19. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.6.4.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with breaker closed, and across each open pole. For single-tank breakers, perform insulation resistance tests from pole-to-pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. *4. 5. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or for control devices that cannot tolerate the voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. With breaker in a test position, perform the following tests: 1. Trip and close breaker with the control switch. 2. Trip breaker by operating each of its protective relays. 3. Verify trip-free and antipump functions. *4. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. 6. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each pole with the breaker open and on each phase with breaker closed. 7. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 87 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.4 Circuit Breakers, SF6 (continued) *8. 9. *10. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. Verify operation of heaters. Test instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare first-trip operation time and trip-coil current waveform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, compare first-trip operation time and tripcoil current waveform to previously obtained results. (7.6.4.1.4) . 2. SF6 gas should have values in accordance with Table 100.13. (7.6.4.1.7) 3. Results of the SF6 gas leak test should confirm that no SF6 gas leak exists. (7.6.4.1.9) 4. Settings for alarm, pressure, and limit switches should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.6.4.1.10) 5. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.6.4.1.13.1) 6. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.6.4.1.13.2) 7. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.6.4.1.13.3) 8. Compare circuit breaker travel and velocity values with manufacturer’s published data and previous test data. (7.6.4.1.17) 9. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.6.4.1.19) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of circuit breakers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1.Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. * Optional Page 88 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.6.4 Circuit Breakers, SF6 (continued) 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Open, close, trip-free, and antipump features should function in accordance with the manufacturer’s design. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils should conform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to Table 100.20. 6. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be compared to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, the comparison shall be made to test data from similar breakers or data from test equipment manufacturers. 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance test values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 8. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 9. Heaters should be operational. 10. Results of electrical tests on instrument transformers should be in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 89 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.7 Circuit Switchers 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform all mechanical operational tests on both the circuit switcher and its operating mechanism. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.7.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 7. Verify operation of SF6 interrupters is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Verify SF6 pressure is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 9. Verify operation of isolating switch is in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Test all interlocking systems for correct operation and sequencing. 11. Verify all indicating and control devices for correct separation. 12. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 13. Perform as-left tests. 14. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. * Optional Page 90 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.7 Circuit Switchers (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.7.1. 2. Perform contact-resistance tests of interrupters and isolating switches. 3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on each pole, phase-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 5. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. 6. Verify correct operation of auxiliary features such as electrical close and trip operation, tripfree, and antipump function. Reset all trip logs and indicators. 7. Trip circuit switcher by operation of each protective device. 8. Verify correct operation of electrical trip of interrupters. 9. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Verify operation of heaters. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.7.1.6.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.7.1.6.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.7.1.6.3) 4. SF6 interrupters should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.7.1.7) 5. SF6 pressure should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.7.1.8) * Optional Page 91 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.7 Circuit Switchers (continued) 3.2 6. Isolating switch should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s design. (7.7.1.9) 7. Interlocking systems should operate per system lockout design. (7.7.1.10) 8. Results of open and close operation from control devices should be in accordance with system design. (7.7.1.11) 9. Operation counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.7.1.14) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar breakers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 3. Insulation-resistance values of circuit switchers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1.Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils should conform to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, refer to Table 100.20. 6. Switcher mechanism charge, close, open, trip, trip-free, and antipump features shall function as designed. 7. Electrical trip interrupters shall function as designed. 8. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the circuit switcher is considered to have passed the test. 9. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 92 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.8. Network Protectors, 600-Volt Class 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect arc chutes. 6. Inspect moving and stationary contacts for condition, wear, and alignment. 7. Verify that maintenance devices are available for servicing and operating the protector. 8. Verify that primary and secondary contact wipe and other dimensions vital to satisfactory operation of the breaker are correct. 9. Perform mechanical operator and contact alignment tests on both the protector and its operating mechanism. 10. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.8.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 11. Verify cell fit and element alignment. 12. Verify racking mechanism operation. 13. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 14. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 93 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.8. Network Protectors, 600-Volt Class (continued) 2. 15. Record the as-found and as-left operations counter readings. 16. Perform a leak test, if applicable, on submersible enclosure in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.8.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with protector closed, and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. *4. Perform insulation-resistance test on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or for control devices that cannot tolerate the voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. *5. Verify current transformer ratios in accordance with Section 7.10. 6. Measure the resistance of each protector power fuse. 7. Measure minimum pickup voltage of the motor control relay. *8. Verify that the motor can charge the closing mechanism at the minimum voltage specified by the manufacturer. 9. Measure minimum pickup voltage of the trip actuator. Verify that the actuator resets correctly. 10. Calibrate the network protector relays in accordance with Section 7.9. 11. Perform operational tests. 1. Verify correct operation of all mechanical and electrical interlocks. 2. Verify trip-free operation. 3. Verify correct operation of the auto-open-close control handle. 4. Verify the protector will close with voltage on the transformer side only. 5. Verify the protector will open when the source feeder breaker is opened. * Optional Page 94 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.8. Network Protectors, 600-Volt Class (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.8.1.10.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.8.1.10.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.8.1.10.3) 4. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. (7.8.1.15) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation resistance of the network protector should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Dielectric withstand voltage tests should not proceed until insulation-resistance levels are raised above minimum values. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar protectors by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Results of current transformer ratios shall be in accordance with Section 7.10. 6. Investigate fuse resistance values that deviate from each other by more than 15 percent. 7. Minimum pickup voltage of the motor control relay should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, but not more than 75 percent of rated control circuit voltage. 8. Minimum acceptable motor closing voltage should not exceed 75 percent of rated control circuit voltage. * Optional Page 95 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.8. Network Protectors, 600-Volt Class (continued) 9. Calibration should not exceed 7.5 percent of rated control circuit voltage. 10. Results of network protector relays should be in accordance with Section 7.9. 11. Network protector operation should be in accordance with design requirements. * Optional Page 96 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect relays and cases for physical damage. 2. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 3. Clean the unit. 4. Relay Case 5. 2. 1. Tighten case connections. 2. Inspect cover for correct gasket seal. 3. Clean cover glass. Inspect shorting hardware, connection paddles, and/or knife switches. 4. Remove any foreign material from the case. 5. Verify target reset Relay 1. Inspect relay for foreign material, particularly in disk slots of the damping and electromagnets. 2. Verify disk clearance. Verify contact clearance and spring bias. 3. Inspect spiral spring convolutions. Inspect disk and contacts for freedom of movement and correct travel. Verify tightness of mounting hardware and connections. Burnish contacts. Inspect bearings and/or pivots. 6. Verify that all settings are in accordance with coordination study or setting sheet supplied by owner. 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform insulation-resistance test on each circuit-to-frame. Procedures for performing insulation-resistance tests on solid-state relays should be determined from the relay manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 97 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 2. 3. Inspect targets and indicators. 1. Determine pickup and dropout of electromechanical targets. 2. Verify operation of all light-emitting diode indicators. 3. Set contrast for liquid-crystal display readouts. Functional Operation 1. 2. 2/62 Timing Relay 1. Determine time delay. 2. Verify operation of instantaneous contacts. 21 Distance Relay 1. Determine maximum reach. 2. Determine maximum torque angle. 3. Determine offset. *4. 3. 4. Plot impedance circle. 24 Volts/Hertz Relay 1. Determine pickup frequency at rated voltage. 2. Determine pickup frequency at a second voltage level. 3. Determine time delay. 25 Sync Check Relay 1. Determine closing zone at rated voltage. 2. Determine maximum voltage differential that permits closing at zero degrees. 3. Determine live line, live bus, dead line, and dead bus set points. 4. Determine time delay. 5. Verify dead bus/live line, dead line/live bus and dead bus/dead line control functions. * Optional Page 98 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 5. 6. 27 Undervoltage Relay 1. Determine dropout voltage. 2. Determine time delay. 3. Determine the time delay at a second point on the timing curve for inverse time relays. 32 Directional Power Relay 1. Determine minimum pickup at maximum torque angle. 2. Determine closing zone. 3. Determine maximum torque angle. 4. Determine time delay. 5. Verify the time delay at a second point on the timing curve for inverse time relays. *6. 7. 40 Loss of Field (Impedance) Relay 1. Determine maximum reach. 2. Determine maximum torque angle. 3. Determine offset. *4. 8. 9. Plot the operating characteristic. Plot impedance circle. 46 Current Balance Relay 1. Determine pickup of each unit. 2. Determine percent slope. 3. Determine time delay. 46N Negative Sequence Current Relay 1. Determine negative sequence alarm level. 2. Determine negative sequence minimum trip level. * Optional Page 99 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 10. 11. 3. Determine maximum time delay. 4. Verify two points on the (I2)2t curve. 47 Phase Sequence or Phase Balance Voltage Relay 1. Determine positive sequence voltage to close the normally open contact. 2. Determine positive sequence voltage to open the normally closed contact (undervoltage trip). 3. Verify negative sequence trip. 4. Determine time delay to close the normally open contact with sudden application of 120 percent of pickup. 5. Determine time delay to close the normally closed contact upon removal of voltage when previously set to rated system voltage. 49R Thermal Replica Relay 1. Determine time delay at 300 percent of setting. 2. Determine a second point on the operating curve. *3. 12. 13. 49T Temperature (RTD) Relay 1. Determine trip resistance. 2. Determine reset resistance. 50 Instantaneous Overcurrent Relay 1. Determine pickup. 2. Determine dropout. *3. 14. Determine pickup. Determine time delay. 51 Time Overcurrent 1. Determine minimum pickup. 2. Determine time delay at two points on the time current curve. * Optional Page 100 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 15. 16. 17. 55 Power Factor Relay 1. Determine tripping angle. 2. Determine time delay. 59 Overvoltage Relay 1. Determine overvoltage pickup. 2. Determine time delay to close the contact with sudden application of 120 percent of pickup. 60 Voltage Balance Relay 1. *2. 18. 19. Determine voltage difference to close the contacts with one source at rated voltage. Plot the operating curve for the relay. 63 Transformer Sudden Pressure Relay 1. Determine rate-of-rise or the pickup level of suddenly applied pressure in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 2. Verify operation of the 63 FPX seal-in circuit. 3. Verify trip circuit to remote operating device. 64 Ground Detector Relay Determine maximum impedance to ground causing relay pickup. 20. 67 Directional Overcurrent Relay 1. Determine directional unit minimum pickup at maximum torque angle. 2. Determine closing zone. *3. Determine maximum torque angle. *4. Plot operating characteristics. 5. Determine overcurrent unit pickup. 6. Determine overcurrent unit time delay at two points on the time current curve. * Optional Page 101 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 21. 79 Reclosing Relay 1. Determine time delay for each programmed reclosing interval. 2. Verify lockout for unsuccessful reclosing. 3. Determine reset time. *4. 5. 22. 23. 24. Determine close pulse duration. Verify instantaneous overcurrent lockout. 81 Frequency Relay 1. Verify frequency set points. 2. Determine time delay. 3. Determine undervoltage cutoff. 85 Pilot Wire Monitor 1. Determine overcurrent pickup. 2. Determine undercurrent pickup. 3. Determine pilot wire ground pickup level. 87 Differential 1. Determine operating unit pickup. 2. Determine the operation of each restraint unit. 3. Determine slope. 4. Determine harmonic restraint. 5. Determine instantaneous pickup. *6. Plot operating characteristics for each restraint. * Optional Page 102 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.1 Protective Relays, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 4. Control Verification Verify that each of the relay contacts performs its intended function in the control scheme including breaker trip tests, close inhibit tests, 86 lockout tests, and alarm functions. 5. Test Values 1. When not otherwise specified, use manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. 2. When critical test points are specified, the relay should be calibrated to those specified points even though other test points may be out of tolerance. * Optional Page 103 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.2 Protective Relays, Microprocessor-Based 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Record model number, style number, serial number, firmware revision, software revision, and rated control voltage. 2. Download all events from the event recorder in filtered and unfiltered mode before performing any tests on the relay. Download the sequence-of-events recorder prior to testing the relay. 3. Verify operation of light-emitting diodes, display, and targets. 4. Record passwords for all access levels. 5. Clean the front panel and remove foreign material from the case. 6. Check tightness of connections. 7. Verify that the frame is grounded in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Download settings from the relay. Print a copy of the settings for the report and compare the settings to those specified in the coordination study. Electrical Tests 1. Perform insulation-resistance tests from each circuit to the grounded frame in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 2. Apply voltage or current to all analog inputs and verify correct registration of the relay meter functions. *3. Functional Operation Check functional operation of each element used in the protection scheme as described for electromechanical and solid-state relays in 7.9.1.3. 4. Control Verification 1. Check operation of all active digital inputs. 2. Check all output contacts or SCRs, preferably by operating the controlled device such as circuit breaker, auxiliary relay, or alarm. *3. 4. Check all internal logic functions used in the protection scheme. For pilot schemes, perform a loop-back test to check the receive and transmit communication circuits. * Optional Page 104 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.9.2 Protective Relays, Microprocessor-Based (continued) *5. For pilot schemes, perform satellite synchronized (GPS) end-to-end tests. 6. For pilot schemes with direct transfer trip (DTT), perform transmit and received DTT at each terminal. 7. Upon completion of testing reset all min/max recorders, fault counters, sequence of events recorder, and all event records. * Optional Page 105 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 3. Clean the unit. 4. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.10.2 and 7.10.3. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 5. Verify that all required grounding and shorting connections provide contact. 6. Verify correct operation of transformer withdrawal mechanism and grounding operation, if applicable. 7. Verify correct primary and secondary fuse sizes for voltage transformers. 8. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 9. Perform as-left tests. 2. Electrical Tests 2.1 Electrical Tests – Current Transformers 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.10.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance test of each current transformer and wiring-to-ground at 1000 volts dc for one minute. For units with solid-state components that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendations. * Optional Page 106 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers (continued) 2.2 *3. Perform a polarity test of each current transformer in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.1. *4. Perform a ratio-verification test using the voltage or current method in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.1. *5. Perform an excitation test on transformers used for relaying applications in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.1. *6. Measure current circuit burdens at transformer terminals. 7. When applicable, perform insulation-resistance tests on the primary winding with the secondary grounded. Test voltages shall be in accordance with Table 100.5. 8. When applicable, perform dielectric withstand voltage tests on the primary winding with the secondary grounded. Test voltages shall be in accordance with Table100.9 respectively. *9. Measure insulation power factor or dissipation factor in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 10. Verify that current circuits are grounded and have only one grounding point in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.3. (IEEE Guide for the Grounding of Instrument Transformer Secondary Circuits and Cases). Electrical Tests – Voltage Transformers 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.10.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute winding-to-winding and each winding-toground. Test voltages shall be applied in accordance with Table 100.5. For units with solidstate components that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendations. *3. 4. Perform a polarity test on each transformer, as applicable, to verify the polarity marks or H1-X1 relationship. Perform a turns-ratio test on all tap positions, if applicable. *5. Measure voltage circuit burdens at transformer terminals. *6. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on the primary windings with the secondary windings connected to ground. The dielectric voltage shall be in accordance with Table 100.9. The test voltage shall be applied for one minute. * Optional Page 107 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers (continued) *7. 8. 2.3 Measure insulation power factor or dissipation factor in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. Verify that potential circuits are grounded and have only one grounding point in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.3. Electrical Tests – Coupling-Capacitor Voltage Transformers 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.10.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute, winding-to-winding and each winding-toground. Test voltages shall be applied in accordance with Table 100.5. For units with solidstate components that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendations. *3. 4. Perform a polarity test on each transformer, as applicable, to verify the polarity marks or H1-X1 relationship. See ANSI/IEEE C93.1 for standard polarity marking. Perform a turns ratio test on the as-found tap position, if applicable. *5. Measure voltage circuit burdens at transformer terminals. *6. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test on the primary windings with the secondary windings connected to ground. The dielectric withstand voltage shall be in accordance with Table 100.9. The test voltage shall be applied for one minute. 7. Measure capacitance of capacitor sections. 8. Measure insulation power factor or dissipation factor in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data 9. Verify that potential circuits are grounded and have only one grounding point in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.13.3. * Optional Page 108 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.10.1.4.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.10.1.4.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.10.1.4.3) 3.2.1 Test Values – Current Transformers – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of instrument transformers should not be less than values shown in Table 100.5. 3. Polarity results should agree with transformer markings. 4. Ratio errors should not be greater than values shown in Table 100.21. 5. Excitation results should match the curve supplied by the manufacturer or be in accordance with ANSI C57.13.1. 6. Compare measured burdens to instrument transformer ratings. 7. Insulation-resistance values of instrument transformers should not be less than values shown in Table 100.5. 8. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the primary winding is considered to have passed the test. 9. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 10. Test results should indicate that the circuits have only one grounding point. * Optional Page 109 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers (continued) 3.2.2 Test Values –Voltage Transformers – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of instrument transformers should not be less than values shown in Table 100.5. 3. Polarity results should agree with transformer markings. 4. In accordance with IEEE C57.13; 8.1.1 the ratio error should be as follows: 1. Revenue metering applications: equal to or less than ±0.1 percent for ratio and ±0.9 mrad (three minutes) for phase angle. 2. Other applications: equal to or less than +1.2 percent for ratio and ±17.5 mrad (one degree) for phase angle. 5. Compare measured burdens to instrument transformer ratings. 6. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the primary windings are considered to have passed the test. 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 8. Test results should indicate that the circuits have only one grounding point. 3.2.3 Test Values – Coupling Capacitor Voltage Transformers 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of instrument transformers should not be less than values shown in Table 100.5. 3. Polarity results should agree with transformer markings. * Optional Page 110 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.10 Instrument Transformers (continued) 4. In accordance with IEEE C57.13; 8.1.1 the ratio error should be as follows: 1. Revenue metering applications: equal to or less than ±0.1 percent for ratio and ±0.9 mrad (three minutes) for phase angle. 2. Other applications: equal to or less than +1.2 percent for ratio and ±17.5 mrad (one degree) for phase angle. 5. Compare measured burdens to instrument transformer ratings. 6. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 7. Capacitance of capacitor sections of coupling-capacitance voltage transformers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 9. Test results should indicate that the circuits have only one grounding point. * Optional Page 111 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.11.1 Metering Devices, Electromechanical and Solid-State 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.11.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 3. Inspect cover gasket, cover glass, condition of spiral spring, disk clearance, contacts, and caseshorting contacts, as applicable. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Verify freedom of movement, end play, and alignment of rotating disk(s). 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.11.1. 2. Verify accuracy of meters at all cardinal points. 3. Calibrate meters in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. *4. Verify all instrument multipliers. * Optional Page 112 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.11.1 Metering Devices, Electromechanical and Solid-State (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.11.1.2.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.11.1.2.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.11.1.2.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Meter accuracy should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 3. Calibration results should be within manufacturer’s specified tolerances. 4. Instrument multipliers should be in accordance with specified system design. * Optional Page 113 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.11.2 Metering Devices, Microprocessor-Based 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect meters and cases for physical damage. 2. Clean front panel . 3. Check tightness of electrical connections. 4. Record model number, serial number, firmware revision, software revision, and rated control voltage. 5. Verify operation of display and indicating devices. 6. Record passwords. 7. Verify unit is grounded in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Verify unit is connected in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions and project drawings. 9. Download settings from the meter, print a copy of the settings for the report, and compare the settings to those specified. Electrical Tests 1. Apply voltage or current as appropriate to each analog input and verify correct measurement and indication. 2. Confirm correct operation and setting of each auxiliary input/output feature in use, including mechanical relay, digital, and analog. 3. Confirm measurements and indications are consistent with loads present. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Tightness of electrical connections shall assure a low resistance connection. (7.11.2.1.3) 2. Display and indicating devices shall operate per manufacturer’s published data. (7.11.2.1.5) 3.2 1. Test Values – Electrical Measurement and indication of applied values of voltage and current should be within manufacturer’s published tolerances for accuracy. * Optional Page 114 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.11.2 Metering Devices, Microprocessor-Based (continued) 2. All auxiliary input/output features should operate per settings and manufacturer’s published data 3. Measurements and indications should be consistent with energized system loads. * Optional Page 115 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.1 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step-Voltage Regulators 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Record position indicator as-found, maximum, and minimum values. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Verify auxiliary device operation. 7. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.12.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 8. Verify correct operation of motor and drive train and automatic motor cutoff at maximum lower and maximum raise positions. 9. Verify correct liquid level in all tanks and bushings. 10. *11. Perform specific inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. Perform an internal inspection: 1. Remove oil. 2. Clean carbon residue and debris from compartment. 3. Inspect contacts for wear and alignment. 4. Inspect all electrical and mechanical connections for tightness using calibrated torque wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 5. Inspect tap-changer compartment terminal board, contact support boards, and insulating operating components for evidence of moisture, cracks, excessive wear, breakage, and/or signs of electrical tracking. * Optional Page 116 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.1 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step Voltage Regulators (continued) 2. 6. Electrically operate tap-changer through full range of taps. 7. Replace gaskets and seal compartment. 8. Fill with filtered oil. 12. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 13. Perform as-left tests. 14. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.12.1.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests on each winding-to-ground in any off-neutral position. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Calculate polarization index. 3. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on windings in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 4. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 5. Measure winding resistance of source windings in the neutral position. Measure the resistance of all taps on load windings. 6. Perform special tests and adjustments as recommended by manufacturer. *7. If the regulator has a separate tap-changer compartment, measure the percentage of oxygen of the nitrogen gas blanket in the main tank. 8. Perform turns-ratio test on each voltage step position. Verify that the tap position indicator correctly identifies all tap positions. 9. Verify accurate operation of voltage range limiter. 10. Verify operation and accuracy of bandwidth, time delay, voltage, and line-drop compensation adjustments of tap-changer control device * Optional Page 117 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.1 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step Voltage Regulators (continued) *11. If regulator has a separate tap-changer compartment, sample insulating liquid in the main tank in accordance with ASTM D 3613 and perform dissolved-gas analysis in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D 3612. 12. Remove a sample of insulating liquid from the main tank or common tank in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 13. *14. 15. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 and/or ASTM D 1816 2. Acid neutralization number: ANSI/ASTM D 974 3. Specific gravity: ANSI/ASTM D 1298 4. Interfacial tension: ANSI/ASTM D 971 or ASTM D 2285 5. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 6. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 *7. Power factor: ASTM D 924 Required when the regulator voltage is 46 kV or higher. *8. PPM water: ASTM D 1533 Required when the regulator voltage is 25 kV or higher and on all silicone-filled units. Remove a sample of insulating liquid from the tap-changer tank in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 Remove a sample of insulating liquid from the tap-changer compartment or common tank in accordance with ASTM D 3613 and perform dissolved-gas analysis (DGA) in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D 3612. Verify operation of heaters. * Optional Page 118 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.1 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step Voltage Regulators (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Auxiliary devices should operate in accordance with system design. (7.12.1.1.1.6) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.12.1.1.1.7.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.12.1.1.1.7.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.12.1.1.1.7.3) 5. Motor, drive train, and automatic cutoff should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s design. (7.12.1.1.1.8) 6. Liquid level in tanks and bushings should be within indicated tolerances. (7.12.1.1.1.9) 7. On internal inspection, contact alignment and wear should be within manufacturer’s recommendations for continued service. (7.12.1.1.1.11.3) 8. Bolt torque levels should be in accordance with Table 100.12 unless otherwise specified by the manufacturer. (7.12.1.1.1.11.4) 9. Terminal board, contact support boards, and insulating operating components should not show signs of moisture, cracking, excessive wear, breakage, or electrical cracking. (7.12.1.1.1.11.5) 10. The tap-changer should operate electrically through the full range of taps. (7.12.1.1.1.11.6) 11. The operation counter should move incrementally for each operation performed. (7.12.1.1.1.14) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. Resistance values shall be temperature corrected in accordance with Table 100.14. The polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results. * Optional Page 119 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.1 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Step Voltage Regulators (continued) 3. Maximum power-factor or dissipation-factor values of liquid-filled regulators should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, compare to test equipment manufacturer’s published data. Representative values are indicated in Table 100.3. 4. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 5. Consult manufacturer if winding-resistance values vary by more than one percent from test results of adjacent windings. 6. Special tests and adjustments should meet manufacturer’s published requirements. 7. Investigate presence of oxygen in nitrogen gas blanket. 8. Turns-ratio test results should maintain a normal deviation between each voltage step and should not deviate more than one-half percent from the calculated voltage ratio. 9. Voltage range limiter should operate within manufacturer’s recommendations. 10. Accuracy of bandwidth, time-delay, voltage, and live drop compensation adjustments should be as specified. 11. Results of dissolved-gas analysis of insulating liquid on the main tank of regulators having a separate tap-changer compartment shall be evaluated in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D 3612. 12. Results of insulating liquid tests on the main tank or common tank of single tank voltage regulators should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 13. Results of insulating liquid tests on the tap-changer tank of regulators having a separate tapchanger compartment should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 14. Compare results of dissolved gas analysis to previous test results. 15. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 120 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.2 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Induction Regulators 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Record position indicator as-found, maximum, and minimum values. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Verify correct auxiliary device operation. 7. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.12.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 8. Check motor and drive train for correct operation and automatic motor cutoff at maximum lower and maximum raise. 9. Verify appropriate liquid level in all tanks and bushings, if applicable. 10. Perform specific inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. 11. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 12. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.12.1.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests winding-to-winding and each winding-to-ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Calculate polarization index. * Optional Page 121 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.2 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Induction Regulators (continued) 3. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on winding insulation in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 4. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 5. Verify voltage regulation. 6. Verify that the indicator correctly identifies neutral position. 7. Perform winding resistance tests on each winding. 8. Sample insulating liquid, if applicable, in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 and/or ASTM D 1816 2. Acid neutralization number: ANSI/ASTM D 974 *3. *9. *10. 11. Specific gravity: ANSI/ASTM D 1298 4. Interfacial tension: ANSI/ASTM D 971 or ASTM D 2285 5. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 6. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 *7. Power factor: ASTM D 924 Required when the regulator voltage is 46 kV or higher. *8. Water content: ASTM D 1533 Required when the regulator voltage is 25 kV or higher. Remove a sample of insulating liquid, if applicable, in accordance with ASTM D 3613 and perform dissolved-gas analysis (DGA) in accordance with ASTM D 3612 or ANSI.IEEE C57.104. Test for the presence of oxygen in the gas blanket of liquid-filled regulators. Verify operation of control cabinet space heater. * Optional Page 122 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.2 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Induction Regulators (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Auxiliary devices should operate in accordance with system design. (7.12.1.2.1.6) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.12.1.2.1.7.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.12.1.2.1.7.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.12.1.2.1.7.3) 5. Motor, drive train, and automatic cutoff should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s design intent and automatic motor cutoff should operate at maximum lower and maximum raise positions. (7.12.1.2.1.8) 6. Liquid level in tanks and bushings should be within indicated tolerances. (7.12.1.2.1.9) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. The polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results. 3. Maximum power-factor or dissipation-factor values of liquid-filled regulators should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, compare to test equipment manufacturer’s published data. Representative values are indicated in Table 100.3. 4. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 5. The regulation should be a linear ratio throughout the range between the maximum raise and the maximum lower positions. 6. Indicator should indicate neutral position correctly. * Optional Page 123 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.1.2 Regulating Apparatus, Voltage, Induction Regulators (continued) 7. Consult the manufacturer if winding-resistance values vary by more than one percent from measurements of adjacent windings. 8. Results of insulating liquid tests should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 9. Evaluate results of dissolved-gas analysis in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104. 10. Investigate presence of oxygen in nitrogen gas blanket. 11. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 124 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.2 Regulating Apparatus, Current – RESERVED – * Optional Page 125 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.3 Regulating Apparatus, Load Tap-Changers 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Record position indicator as-found, maximum, and minimum values. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.12.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 7. Verify correct auxiliary device operation. 8. Verify motor and drive train for correct operation and automatic motor cutoff at maximum lower and maximum raise. 9. Verify correct liquid level in all tanks. 10. Perform specific inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. 11. Visually inspect wear/erosion indicators on vacuum bottles, if applicable. *12. Perform an internal inspection: 1. Remove oil. 2. Clean carbon residue and debris from compartment. 3. Inspect contacts for wear and alignment. * Optional Page 126 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.3 Regulating Apparatus, Load Tap-Changers (continued) 2. 4. Inspect all electrical and mechanical connections for tightness using calibrated torquewrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 5. Inspect tap-changer compartment terminal board, contact support boards, and insulated operating components for evidence of moisture, cracks, excessive wear, breakage, and/or signs of electrical tracking. 6. Electrically operate tap-changer through full range of taps. 7. Replace gaskets and seal compartment. 8. Fill with filtered oil. 13. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 14. Perform as-left tests. 15. Record as-found and as-left operation counter readings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.12.3.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests in any off-neutral position in accordance with Section 7.2.2. 3. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests in off-neutral position in accordance with Section 7.2.2. *4. Perform winding-resistance test. 5. Perform special tests and adjustments as recommended by the manufacturer. 6. Perform turns-ratio test at all tap positions. 7. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 923. The sample shall be tested for the following in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 and/or ASTM D 1816 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 * Optional Page 127 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.3 Regulating Apparatus, Load Tap-Changers (continued) 8. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 3613 and perform dissolved gas analysis (DGA) in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D 3612. 9. Perform vacuum bottle integrity tests (dielectric withstand voltage) across each vacuum bottle with the contacts in the open position in strict accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Verify operation of heaters. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.12.3.1.6.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.12.3.1.6.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.12.3.1.6.3) 4. Auxiliary device operation should be in accordance with design intent. (7.12.3.1.7) 5. Motor, drive train, and automatic cutoff should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s design intent and automatic motor cutoff should operate at maximum lower and maximum raise positions. 6. Liquid level in tanks should be within indicated tolerances. (7.12.3.1.9) 7. Vacuum bottle wear/erosion indicators should be within manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. (7.12.3.1.11) 8. Contact wear and alignment should be within manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. (7.12.3.1.12.3) 9. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.12.3.1.12.4) 10. No evidence of moisture, cracks, excessive wear, breakage, or electrical tracking should be found. (7.12.3.1.12.5) 11. The tap-changer should operate through the full range of taps. (7.12.3.1.12.6) 12. Operations counter should have had an incremental change in accordance with tap-changer operation. (7.12.3.1.15) * Optional Page 128 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.12.3 Regulating Apparatus, Load Tap-Changers (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Maximum winding insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor values of liquid-filled transformers should be in accordance with manufacturer’s specifications. Representative values are indicated in Table 100.3. Also, compare with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 4. Consult the manufacturer if winding-resistance values vary by more than one percent from measurements of adjacent windings. 5. Special tests and adjustments should conform to manufacturer’s specifications. 6. Turns-ratio test results should maintain a normal deviation between each voltage step and should not deviate more than one-half percent from the calculated voltage ratio. 7. Results of insulating liquid tests should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 8. Evaluate results of dissolved-gas analysis in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104. 9. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 10. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 129 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.13 Grounding Systems 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Verify ground system is in compliance with ANSI/NFPA 70, National Electrical Code, Article 250. 2. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 3. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 4. 2. 1. Use of low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.13.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. Inspect anchorage. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with section 7.13.1. 2. Perform fall-of-potential or alternative test in accordance with IEEE Standard 81 on the main grounding electrode or system. 3. Perform point-to-point tests to determine the resistance between the main grounding system and all major electrical equipment frames, system neutral, and/or derived neutral points. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Grounding system electrical and mechanical connections should be free of corrosion. (7.13.1.2) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.13.1.3.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.13.1.3.2) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. * Optional Page 130 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.13 Grounding Systems (continued) 2. The resistance between the main grounding electrode and ground should be no greater than five ohms for large commercial or industrial systems and 1.0 ohm or less for generating or transmission station grounds unless otherwise specified by the owner. (Reference ANSI/IEEE Standard 142) 3. Investigate point-to-point resistance values which exceed 0.5 ohm. * Optional Page 131 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.14 Ground-Fault Protection Systems, Low-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. 2. Inspect the components for damage and errors in polarity or conductor routing. 1. Verify that the ground connection is made on the source side of the neutral disconnect link and also on the source side of any ground fault sensor. 2. Verify that the neutral sensors are connected with correct polarity on both primary and secondary. 3. Verify that all phase conductors and the neutral pass through the sensor in the same direction for zero sequence systems. 4. Verify that grounding conductors do not pass through zero sequence sensors. 5. Verify that the grounded conductor is solidly grounded. 2. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 3. Clean the unit. 4. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.14.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 5. Verify correct operation of all functions of the self-test panel, if applicable. 6. Verify pickup and time-delay settings in accordance with the settings provided in the owner’s specifications. Record appropriate operation and test sequences as required by ANSI/NFPA 70 National Electrical Code, Article 230.95. 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.14.1. 2. Measure the system neutral-to-ground insulation resistance with the neutral disconnect link temporarily removed. Replace neutral disconnect link after testing. * Optional Page 132 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.14 Ground-Fault Protection Systems, Low-Voltage (continued) *3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 4. Perform ground fault protective device pickup tests using primary current injection. 5. For summation type systems utilizing phase and neutral current transformers, verify correct polarities by applying current to each phase-neutral current transformer pair. This test also applies to molded-case breakers utilizing an external neutral current transformer. 6. Measure time delay of the ground fault protective device at a value equal to or greater than 150 percent of the pickup value. 7. Verify that reduced control voltage tripping capability is 55 percent for ac systems and 80 percent for dc systems. 8. Verify blocking capability of zone interlock systems. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.14.1.4.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.14.1.4.2) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. System neutral-to-ground insulation resistance should be a minimum of one megohm. 3. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 4. Results of pickup test should be greater than 90 percent of the ground fault protection device pickup setting and less than 1200 amperes or 125 percent of the pickup setting, whichever is smaller. * Optional Page 133 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.14 Ground-Fault Protection Systems, Low-Voltage (continued) 5. The ground fault protective device should operate when current direction is the same relative to polarity marks in the two current transformers. The ground fault protective device should not operate when current direction is opposite relative to polarity marks in the two current transformers. 6. Relay timing should be in accordance with manufacturer’s specifications but must be no longer than one second at 3000 amperes in accordance with ANSI/NFPA 70, National Electrical Code, Article 230.95. 7. The circuit interrupting device should operate when control voltage is 55 percent of nominal voltage for ac circuits and 80 percent of nominal voltage for dc circuits. 8. Results of zone-blocking tests should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and/or design specifications. * Optional Page 134 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.1 Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Inspect air baffles, filter media, cooling fans, slip rings, brushes, and brush rigging. 4. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.15.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 5. Perform special tests such as air-gap spacing and machine alignment, if applicable. 6. Verify the application of appropriate lubrication and lubrication systems. 7. Verify the absence of unusual mechanical or electrical noise or signs of overheating. 8. Verify that resistance temperature detector (RTD) circuits conform to drawings. Electrical Tests – AC Induction 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.15.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. 1. Machines larger than 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts): Test duration shall be for ten minutes. Calculate polarization index. 2. Machines 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts) and less: Test duration shall be for one minute. Calculate the dielectric-absorption ratio. 3. Perform dc dielectric withstand voltage tests on machines rated at 2300 volts and greater in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 95. 4. Perform phase-to-phase stator resistance test on machines 2300 volts and greater. *5. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests. * Optional Page 135 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.1 Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators (continued) *6. Perform power-factor tip-up tests. *7. Perform surge comparison tests. 8. Perform insulation-resistance test on insulated bearings in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, if applicable. 9. Test surge protection devices in accordance with Section 7.19 and Section 7.20. 10. Test motor starter in accordance with Section 7.16. 11. Perform resistance tests on resistance temperature detector (RTD) circuits. 12. Verify operation of machine space heater, if applicable. *13. Perform vibration test. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Inspection (7.15.1.1.3) 1. Air baffles should be clean. 2. Filter media should be clean. 3. Cooling fans should operate. 4. Slip ring wear should be within manufacturer’s tolerances for continued use. 5. Brushes should be within manufacturer’s tolerances for continued use. 6. Brush rigging should be intact. 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.15.1.1.4.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.15.1.1.4.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.15.1.1.4.3) * Optional Page 136 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.1 Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical Tests 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate any values that deviate from similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. The dielectric absorption ratio or polarization shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. The recommended minimum insulation resistance (IR 1 min) test results in megohms should be corrected to 40° C and read as follows: 1. IR 1 min = kV + 1 for most windings made before 1970, all field windings, and others not described in 2.2 and 2.3. (kV is the rated machine terminal-to-terminal voltage in rms kV) 2. IR 1 min = 100 megohms for most dc armature and ac windings built after 1970 (formwound coils). 3. IR 1 min = 5 megohms for most machines and random-wound stator coils and formwound coils rated below 1 kV. NOTE: Dielectric withstand voltage and surge comparison tests shall not be performed on machines having values lower than those indicated above. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 4. Investigate phase-to-phase stator resistance values that deviate by more than five percent. 5. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be compared with previous values of similar machines. 6. Tip-up values should indicate no significant increase in power factor. 7. If no evidence of distress, insulation failure, or lack of waveform nesting is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the surge comparison test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 8. Bearing insulation-resistance measurements should be within manufacturer’s published tolerances. In the absence of manufacturer’s published tolerances, the comparison shall be made to similar machines. 9. Test results of surge protection devices shall be in accordance with Section 7.19 and Section 7.20. * Optional Page 137 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.1 Rotating Machinery, AC Induction Motors and Generators (continued) 10. Test results of motor starter equipment shall be in accordance with Section 7.16. 11. RTD circuits should conform to design intent and/or machine protection device manufacturer’s specifications. 12. Heaters should be operational. 13. Vibration amplitudes of the uncoupled and unloaded machine should not exceed values shown in Table 100.10. If values exceed those in Table 100.10, perform complete vibration analysis. * Optional Page 138 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Inspect air baffles, filter media, cooling fans, slip rings, brushes, and brush rigging. 4. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.15.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 5. Perform special tests such as air-gap spacing and machine alignment, if applicable. 6. Verify the application of appropriate lubrication and lubrication systems. 7. Verify the absence of unusual mechanical or electrical noise or signs of overheating. 8. Verify that resistance temperature detector (RTD) circuits conform to drawings. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.15.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. 1. Machines larger than 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts): Test duration shall be for ten minutes. Calculate polarization index. 2. Machines 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts) and less: Test duration shall be for one minute. Calculate the dielectric-absorption ratio. 3. Perform dc dielectric withstand voltage tests on machines rated at 2300 volts and greater in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 95. 4. Perform phase-to-phase stator resistance test on machines 2300 volts and greater. *5. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests. * Optional Page 139 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators (continued) *6. Perform power-factor tip-up tests. *7. Perform surge comparison tests. 8. Perform insulation-resistance test on insulated bearings in accordance with manufacturer’s published data, if applicable. 9. Test surge protection devices in accordance with Section 7.19 and Section 7.20. 10. Test motor starter in accordance with Section 7.16. 11. Perform resistance tests on resistance temperature detector (RTD) circuits. 12. Verify operation of machine space heater, if applicable. *13. 14. Perform vibration test. Perform insulation-resistance tests on the main rotating field winding, the exciter-field winding, and the exciter-armature winding in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. *15. Perform an ac voltage-drop test on all rotating field poles. *16. Perform a high-potential test on the excitation system in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 421.3. 17. *18. Measure resistance of machine-field winding, exciter-stator winding, exciter-rotor windings, and field discharge resistors. Perform front-to-back resistance tests on diodes and gating tests of silicon-controlled rectifiers for field application semiconductors. 19. Prior to re-energizing, apply voltage to the exciter supply and adjust exciter-field current to nameplate value. 20. Verify that the field application timer and the enable timer for the power-factor relay have been tested and set to the motor drive manufacturer’s recommended values. *21. Record stator current, stator voltage, and field current for the complete acceleration period including stabilization time for a normally loaded starting condition. From the recording determine the following information: 1. Bus voltage prior to start. 2. Voltage drop at start. 3. Bus voltage at machine full-load. * Optional Page 140 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators (continued) 4. Locked-rotor current. 5. Current after synchronization but before loading. 6. Current at maximum loading. 7. Acceleration time to near synchronous speed. 8. RPM just prior to synchronization. 9. Field application time. 10. Time to reach stable synchronous operation. *22. Plot a V-curve of stator current versus excitation current at approximately 50 percent load to check correct exciter operation. *23. If the range of exciter adjustment and machine loading permit, reduce excitation to cause power factor to fall below the trip value of the power-factor relay. Verify relay operation. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Inspection (7.15.2.1.3) 1. Air baffles should be clean. 2. Filter media should be clean. 3. Cooling fans should operate. 4. Slip ring wear should be within manufacturer’s tolerances for continued use. 5. Brushes should be within manufacturer’s tolerances for continued use. 6. Brush rigging should be intact. 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate any values that deviate from similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.15.2.1.4.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.15.2.1.4.2) 4. Results of thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.15.2.1.4.3) * Optional Page 141 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate any values that deviate from similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. The dielectric absorption ratio or polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. The recommended minimum insulation resistance (IR 1 min) test results in megohms should be corrected to 40° C and read as follows: 1. IR 1 min = kV + 1 for most windings made before 1970, all field windings and others not described in 2.2 and 2.3. (kV is the rated machine terminal-to-terminal voltage in rms kV) 2. IR 1 min = 100 megohms for most dc armature and ac windings built after 1970 (formwound coils). 3. IR 1 min = 5 megohms for most machines and random-wound stator coils and formwound coils rated below 1 kV. NOTE: Dielectric withstand voltage, high-potential, and surge comparison tests shall not be performed on machines having values lower than those indicated above. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 4. Investigate phase-to-phase stator resistance values that deviate by more than five percent. 5. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values shall be compared with previous values of similar machines. 6. Tip-up values should indicate no significant increase in power factor. 7. If no evidence of distress, insulation failure, or lack of waveform nesting is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the surge comparison test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 8. Insulation resistance of bearings should be within manufacturer’s published tolerances. In the absence of manufacturer’s published tolerances, the comparison shall be made to similar machines. 9. Test results of surge protection devices shall be in accordance with Section 7.19 and Section 7.20. * Optional Page 142 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators (continued) 10. Test results of motor starter equipment shall be in accordance with Section 7.16. 11. RTD circuits should conform to design intent and/or machine protection device manufacturer’s specifications. 12. Heaters should be operational. 13. Vibration amplitudes of the uncoupled and unloaded machine should not exceed values shown in Table 100.10. If values exceed those in Table 100.10, perform complete vibration analysis. 14. The recommended minimum insulation resistance (IR1 min) test results in megohms should be corrected to 40° C and read as follows: 1. IR 1 min = kV + 1 for most windings made before 1970, all field windings, and others not described in 2.2 and 2.3. (kV is the rated machine terminal-to-terminal voltage in rms kV) 2. IR 1 min = 100 megohms for most dc armature and ac windings built after 1970 (formwound coils). 3. IR 1 min = 5 megohms for most machines and random-wound stator coils and formwound coils rated below 1 kV. NOTE: Dielectric withstand voltage, high-potential, and surge comparison tests shall not be performed on machines having values lower than those indicated above. 15. The pole-to-pole ac voltage drop shall not exceed 10 percent variance between poles. 16. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage, test, the winding is considered to have passed the test. 17. The measured resistance values of motor-field windings, exciter-stator windings, exciter-rotor windings, and field-discharge resistors shall be compared to manufacturer’s recommended values. 18. Resistance test results of diodes and gating tests of silicon-controlled rectifiers should be in accordance with industry standards and system design requirements. 19. Exciter power supply should allow exciter-field current to be adjusted to nameplate value. 20. Application timer and enable timer for power factor relay test results should comply with manufacturer’s recommended values. * Optional Page 143 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.2 Rotating Machinery, Synchronous Motors and Generators (continued) 21. Recorded values should be in accordance with system design requirements. 22. Plotted V-curve should indicate correct exciter operation. 23. When reduced excitation falls below trip value for the power-factor relay, the relay should operate. * Optional Page 144 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.3 Rotating Machinery, DC Motors and Generators 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Inspect air baffles, field media, cooling fans, brushes, and brush rigging. 4. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.15.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 5. Inspect commutator and tachometer generator. 6. Perform special tests such as air-gap spacing and machine alignment, if applicable. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.15.3.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all windings in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. 3. *4. 5. *6. 7. 1. Machines larger than 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts): Test duration shall be for ten minutes. Calculate polarization index. 2. Machines 200 horsepower (150 kilowatts) and less: Test duration shall be for one minute. Calculate the dielectric absorption ratio. Perform high-potential test in accordance with NEMA MG 1, paragraph 3.01. Perform an ac voltage-drop test on all field poles. Measure armature running current and field current or voltage. Compare to nameplate. Perform vibration tests. Verify that all protective devices are in accordance with Section 7.16. * Optional Page 145 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.3 Rotating Machinery, DC Motors and Generators (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. 3.2 Inspection (7.15.3.1.3) 1. Air baffles should be clean 2. Filter media should be clean. 3. Cooling fans should operate. 4. Brushes should be within manufacturer’s tolerances for continued use. 5. Brush rigging should be intact. 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate any values that deviate from similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.15.3.1.4.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.15.3.1.4.2) 4. Results of thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.15.3.1.4.3) 5. Commutator and tachometer generator should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and/or system design. (7.15.3.1.5) 6. Air-gap spacing and machine alignment should be within manufacturer’s recommendations. (7.15.3.1.6) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate any values that deviate from similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. The dielectric absorption ratio or polarization index shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. The recommended minimum insulation resistance (IR1 min) test results in megohms should be corrected to 40° C and read as follows: 1. IR 1 min = kV + 1 for most windings made before 1970, all field windings, and others not described in 2.2 and 2.3. (kV is the rated machine terminal-to-terminal voltage, in rms kV) * Optional Page 146 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.15.3 Rotating Machinery, DC Motors and Generators (continued) 2. IR 1 min = 100 megohms for most dc armature and ac windings built after 1970 (formwound coils). 3. IR 1 min = 5 megohms for most machines and random-wound stator coils and formwound coils rated below 1 kV. NOTE: Dielectric withstand voltage, high-potential, and surge comparison tests shall not be performed on machines having values lower than those indicated above. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand test, the winding is considered to have passed the test. 4. The pole-to-pole voltage drop shall not exceed five percent variance between poles. 5. Measured running current and field current or voltage should be comparable to nameplate data. 6. Vibration amplitudes of the uncoupled and unloaded machine should not exceed values shown in Table 100.10. If values exceed those in Table 100.10, perform complete vibration analysis. 7. Test results of motor starter equipment shall be in accordance with Section 7.16. * Optional Page 147 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.1 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Low-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect contactors. *6. 7. 1. Verify mechanical operation. 2. Inspect and adjust contact gap, wipe, alignment, and pressure in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. Motor-Running Protection 1. Compare overload element rating with motor full-load current rating to verify correct sizing. 2. If motor-running protection is provided by fuses, verify correct fuse rating considering motor characteristics and power-factor correction capacitors. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.16.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 8. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 9. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 148 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.1 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Low-Voltage (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.16.1.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with starter closed, and across each open pole. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.1. *3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 4. Test motor protection devices in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, use Section 7.19. 5. Test circuit breakers in accordance with Section 7.6.1.1. 6. Perform operational tests by initiating control devices. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.16.1.1.1.7.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.16.1.1.1.7.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.16.1.1.1.7.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. * Optional Page 149 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.1 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Low-Voltage (continued) 3. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 4. Motor protection parameters shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Section 7.9. 5. Circuit breaker test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.6.1.1. 6. Control devices should perform in accordance with system design and/or requirements. * Optional Page 150 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.2 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition including evidence of moisture and corona. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.16.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 6. Test electrical and mechanical interlock systems for correct operation and sequencing. 7. Verify correct barrier and shutter installation and operation. 8. Exercise active components and confirm correct operation of indicating devices. 9. Inspect contactors. 1. Verify mechanical operation. 2. Inspect and adjust contact gap, wipe, alignment, and pressure in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Compare overload protection rating with motor nameplate to verify correct size. Set adjustable or programmable devices according to the protective device coordination study. 11. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 12. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 151 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.2 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.16.1.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests on contactor(s) for one minute, phase-to-ground and phaseto-phase with the contactor closed, and across each open contact. Test voltage shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.1. *3. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. *4. Perform a dielectric withstand voltage test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.19. 5. Perform vacuum bottle integrity test (dielectric withstand voltage), if applicable, across each vacuum bottle with the contacts in the open position in strict accordance with manufacturer’s published data. Do not exceed maximum voltage stipulated for this test. 6. Perform contact resistance tests. 7. Measure blowout coil circuit resistance, if applicable. 8. Measure resistance of power fuses. 9. Energize contactor using an auxiliary source. Adjust armature to minimize operating vibration where applicable. 10. Test control power transformers in accordance with Section 7.1.2.8. 11. Test starting transformers, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.2.1. 12. Test starting reactors, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.20.3. 13. Test motor protection devices in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, test in accordance with Section 7.9. *14. 15. Perform system function test in accordance with Section 8. Verify operation of cubicle space heater. * Optional Page 152 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.2 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.16.1.2.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.16.1.2.1.5.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.16.1.2.1.5.3) 4. Electrical and mechanical interlocks should operate in accordance with system design. (7.16.1.2.1.6) 5. Barrier and shutter installation and operation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s design. (7.16.1.2.1.7) 6. Indicating devices should operate in accordance with system design. (7.16.1.2.1.8) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.5. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 4. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 5. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the vacuum bottle integrity test, the vacuum bottle is considered to have passed the test. 6. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, * Optional Page 153 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.1.2 Motor Control, Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage (continued) investigate values which deviate from those of similar connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 7. Resistance values of blowout coils should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Resistance values should not deviate by more than 15 percent between identical fuses. 9. Contactor coil should operate with minimal vibration and noise. 10. Control power transformer test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.1.2.8. 11. Starting transformer test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.2.1. 12. Starting reactor test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.20.3. 13. Motor protection parameters shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 14. System function test results should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and/or system design. 15. Heaters should be operational. * Optional Page 154 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.16.2.1 Motor Control, Motor Control Centers, Low-Voltage 1. Refer to Section 7.1 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center bus. 2. Refer to Section 7.5.1.1 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center switches. 3. Refer to Section 7.6 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center circuit breakers. 4. Refer to Section 7.16.1.1 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center starters. 7.16.2.2 Motor Control, Motor Control Centers, Medium-Voltage 1. Refer to Section 7.1 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center bus. 2. Refer to Section 7.5.1.2 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center switches. 3. Refer to Section 7.6 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center circuit breakers. 4. Refer to Section 7.16.1.2 for appropriate inspections and tests of the motor control center starters. * Optional Page 155 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.17 Adjustable-Speed Drive Systems 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Ensure vent path openings are free from debris and that heat transfer surfaces are not contaminated by oil, dust, or dirt. 6. Verify correct connections of circuit boards, wiring, disconnects, and ribbon cables. 7. Motor running protection 8. 9. 10. 1. Compare drive overcurrent set points with motor full-load current rating to verify correct settings. 2. If drive is used to operate multiple motors, compare individual overload element ratings with motor full-load current ratings. 3. Apply minimum and maximum speed set points. Confirm set points are within limitations of the load coupled to the motor. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.17.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Verify correct fuse sizing in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 156 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.17 Adjustable-Speed Drive Systems (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.17.1. 2. Test the motor overload relay elements by injecting primary current through the overload circuit and monitoring trip time of the overload element. 3. Test input circuit breaker by primary injection in accordance with Section 7.6. *4. Perform insulation resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 5. Test for the following parameters in accordance with relay calibration procedures outlined in Section 7.9 or as recommended by the manufacturer: 1. Input phase loss protection 2. Input overvoltage protection 3. Output phase rotation 4. Overtemperature protection 5. DC overvoltage protection 6. Overfrequency protection 7. Drive overload protection 8. Fault alarm outputs 6. Perform continuity tests on bonding conductors in accordance with Section 7.13. 7. Perform operational tests by initiating control devices. 1. Slowly vary drive speed between minimum and maximum. Observe motor and load for unusual noise or vibration. 2. Verify operation of drive from remote start/stop and speed control signals. * Optional Page 157 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.17 Adjustable-Speed Drive Systems (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.17.1.8.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.17.1.8.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.17.1.8.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Overload test trip times at 300 percent of overload element rating should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published time-current curve. 3. Input circuit breaker test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.6. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Relay calibration test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.9. 6. Continuity of bonding conductors shall be in accordance with Section 7.13. 7. Control devices should perform in accordance with system requirements. * Optional Page 158 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.1 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Flooded Lead-Acid 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Verify the battery area ventilation system is operable. 2. Verify existence of suitable eyewash equipment. 3. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 4. Inspect battery support racks, mounting, battery spill containment system, anchorage, clearances, alignment, and grounding. 5. Prior to cleaning or adding electrolyte, perform as-found tests, if applicable. 6. Verify electrolyte level. Measure electrolyte specific gravity and temperature levels. 7. Verify presence of flame arresters. 8. Neutralize acid on exterior surfaces and rinse with water. 9. Clean corroded/oxidized terminals and apply an oxide inhibitor. 10. 11. 2. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.18.1.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey under load in accordance with Section 9. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.18.1.1.1. 2. Measure charger float and equalizing voltage levels. Adjust to battery manufacturer’s recommended settings. 3. Verify all charger functions and alarms. 4. Measure each cell voltage and total battery voltage with charger energized and in float mode of operation. * Optional Page 159 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.1 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Flooded Lead-Acid (continued) 5. Measure intercell connection resistances. 6. Perform internal ohmic measurement tests. *7. Perform a load test in accordance with manufacturer’s specifications or ANSI/IEEE 450, Recommended Practice for Maintenance, Testing and Replacement of Large Lead Storage Batteries for Generating Stations and Substations. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Electrolyte level and specific gravity should be within normal limits. (7.18.1.1.1.6) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.18.1.1.1.10.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.18.1.1.1.10.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.18.1.1.1.10.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Charger float and equalize voltage levels should be in accordance with battery manufacturer’s published data. 3. The results of charger functions and alarms should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 4. Cell voltages should be within 0.05 volt of each other or in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 5. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 6. Cell internal ohmic values (resistance, impedance or conductance) values should not vary by more than 25 percent between identical cells that are in a fully charged state. * Optional Page 160 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.1 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Flooded Lead-Acid (continued) 7. Results of load tests should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or ANSI/IEEE 450. * Optional Page 161 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.2 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Vented Nickel-Cadmium 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Verify that battery area ventilation system is operable. 2. Verify existence of suitable eyewash equipment. 3. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 4. Verify adequacy of battery support racks or cabinets, mounting, battery spill containment system, anchorage, alignment, grounding, and clearances. 5. Prior to cleaning or adding electrolyte, perform as-found tests. 6. Verify electrolyte level and measure pilot-cell electrolyte temperature. 7. Verify the units are clean. 8. Verify application of an oxide inhibitor on battery terminal connections. 9. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.18.1.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 10. Perform as-left tests. 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.18.1.2.1. 2. Measure charger float and equalizing voltage levels. Adjust to battery manufacturer’s recommended settings. 3. Verify all charger functions and alarms. 4. Measure each cell voltage and total battery voltage with charger energized and in float mode of operation. 5. Measure intercell connection resistances. * Optional Page 162 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.2 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Vented Nickel-Cadmium (continued) 6. *7. 8. Perform internal ohmic measurement tests. Perform a load test in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or ANSI/IEEE 1106. Measure the battery system voltage from positive-to-ground and negative-to-ground. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Electrolyte level shall be within normal limits. (7.18.1.2.1.7) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.18.1.2.1.10.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels shall be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.18.1.2.1.10.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.18.1.2.1.10.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Charger float and equalize voltage levels should be in accordance with battery manufacturer’s published data. 3. The results of charger functions and alarms should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 4. Cell voltages should be within 0.05 volt of each other or in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 5. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 6. Cell internal ohmic values (resistance, impedance, or conductance) should not vary by more than 25 percent between identical cells that are in a fully charged state, or should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 163 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.2 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Vented Nickel-Cadmium (continued) 7. Results of load tests should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or ANSI/IEEE 1106. 8. Voltage measured from positive-to-ground should be equal in magnitude to the voltage measured from negative-to-ground. * Optional Page 164 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.3 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Valve-Regulated Lead-Acid 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Verify the battery ventilation system is operable. 2. Verify the existence of suitable eyewash equipment. 3. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 4. Inspect battery support racks or cabinets, mounting, anchorage, clearances, alignment, and grounding. 5. Prior to cleaning, perform as-found tests. 6. Neutralize acid on exterior surfaces and rinse with water. 7. Clean corroded/oxidized terminals and apply an oxide inhibitor. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 2. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.18.1.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey under load in accordance with Section 9. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.18.1.3.1. 2. Measure negative post temperature. 3. Measure charger float and equalizing voltage levels. 4. Verify all charger functions and alarms. 5. Measure each monoblock/cell voltage and total battery voltage with charger energized and in float mode of operation. 6. Measure intercell connection resistances. 7. Perform internal ohmic measurement tests. * Optional Page 165 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.1.3 Direct-Current Systems, Batteries, Valve-Regulated Lead-Acid (continued) 8. Perform an annual load test in accordance with manufacturer’s specifications or IEEE 1188, Recommended Practice for Maintenance, Testing and Replacement of Valve-Regulated LeadAcid (VRLA) Batteries for Stationary Applications. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.18.1.3.9.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.18.1.3.9.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.18.1.3.9.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values that deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Negative post temperature should be within manufacturer’s published data or IEEE 1188. 3. Charger float and equalize voltage levels should be in accordance with the battery manufacturer’s published data. 4. Results of charger functions and alarms should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 5. Monoblock/cell voltages should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 6. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 7. Monoblock/cell internal ohmic values (resistance, impedance, or conductance) should not vary by more than 25 percent between identical monoblocks/cells that are in a fully charged state. 8. Results of load tests should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or IEEE 1188. * Optional Page 166 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.2 Direct-Current Systems, Chargers 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect for physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect all bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.18.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey under load in accordance with Section 9. 6. Inspect filter and tank capacitors. 7. Verify operation of cooling fans. Clean filters if provided. 8. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through all bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.18.2.1. 2. Verify float voltage, equalize voltage, and high-voltage shutdown settings. 3. Verify current limit. 4. Verify correct load sharing (parallel chargers). 5. Verify calibration of meters in accordance with Section 7.11. 6. Verify operation of alarms. 7. Measure and record input and output voltage and current. 8. Measure and record ac ripple current and/or voltage imposed on battery. *9. Perform full load testing of charger. * Optional Page 167 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.2 Direct-Current Systems, Chargers (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.18.2.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.18.2.1.5.1) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.18.2.1.5.1) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values that deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Float and equalize voltage settings should be in accordance with the battery manufacturer’s published data. 3. Current limit should be within manufacturer’s recommended maximum. 4. Results of load sharing between parallel chargers should be in accordance with system design specifications. 5. Results of meter calibration should be in accordance with Section 7.11. 6. Results of alarm operation should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and system design. 7. Input and output voltage should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. AC ripple current and/or voltage imposed on the battery should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 9. Charger should be capable of manufacturer’s specified full load. * Optional Page 168 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.18.3 Direct-Current Systems, Rectifiers – RESERVED – * Optional Page 169 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.19.1 Surge Arresters, Low-Voltage Surge Protection Devices 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.19.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 6. Verify that the ground lead on each device is individually attached to a ground bus or ground electrode. 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.19.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance test on each arrester, from the phase terminal to ground. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Test grounding connection in accordance with Section 7.13. * Optional Page 170 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.19.1 Surge Arresters, Low-Voltage Surge Protection Devices (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.19.1.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.19.1.1.5.2) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Resistance between the arrester ground terminal and the ground system should be less than 0.5 ohm and in accordance with Section 7.13. * Optional Page 171 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.19.2 Surge Arresters, Medium- and High-Voltage Surge Protection Devices 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.19.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 6. Verify that the ground lead on each device is individually attached to a ground bus or ground electrode. 7. Verify that stroke counter, if present, is correctly mounted and electrically connected. 8. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.19.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests from phase terminals(s) to case for one minute. Test voltage and minimum resistance shall be in accordance with manufacturer's published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, refer to Table 100.1. 3. Test the grounding connection in accordance with Section 7.13. *4. Perform a watts-loss test in accordance with test equipment manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 172 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.19.2 Surge Arresters, Medium- and High-Voltage Surge Protection Devices (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.19.2.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.19.2.1.5.2) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated 3. Resistance between the arrester ground terminal and the ground system should be less than 0.5 ohm and in accordance with Section 7.13. 4. Watts loss values are evaluated on a comparison basis with similar units and test equipment manufacturer’s published data. * Optional Page 173 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.1 Capacitors and Reactors, Capacitors 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Verify that capacitors are electrically connected in their specified configuration. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 7. 2. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.20.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable. See Section 7.20.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests from phase terminal(s) to case for one minute. Test voltage and minimum resistance shall be in accordance with manufacturer's published data. In the absence of manufacturer's published data, refer to Table 100.1. 3. Measure the capacitance of all terminal combinations. 4. Measure resistance of internal discharge resistors. * Optional Page 174 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.1 Capacitors and Reactors, Capacitors (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.20.1.1.6.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.20.1.1.6.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.20.1.1.6.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated 3. Investigate capacitance values differing from manufacturer’s published data. 4. Investigate discharge resistor values differing from manufacturer’s published data. In accordance with ANSI/NFPA 70 National Electrical Code, Article 460, residual voltage of a capacitor shall be reduced to 50 volts in the following time intervals after being disconnected from the source of supply: Rated Voltage 600 volts > 600 volts Discharge Time 1 minute 5 minutes * Optional Page 175 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.2 Capacitors and Reactors, Capacitor Control Devices – RESERVED – * Optional Page 176 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.1 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Dry Type 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspections 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.20.3.1.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 6. Verify that tap connections are as specified, if applicable. 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.20.3.1.1. 2. Perform winding-to-ground insulation-resistance tests. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Measure winding resistance. *4. Perform dielectric withstand voltage tests on each winding-to-ground. * Optional Page 177 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.1 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Dry Type (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.20.3.1.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.20.3.1.1.5.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.20.3.1.1.5.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. If winding-resistance test results vary by more than one percent from factory tests, consult the manufacturer. 4. AC dielectric withstand test voltage shall not exceed 75 percent of factory test voltage for one minute duration. DC dielectric withstand test voltage shall not exceed 100 percent of the factory rms test voltage for one minute duration. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. * Optional Page 178 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.2 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Liquid-Filled 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Verify settings and operation of all temperature devices, if applicable. 6. Verify that cooling fans and pumps operate correctly and that fan and pump motors have correct overcurrent protection, if applicable. 7. Verify operation of all alarm, control, and trip circuits from temperature and level indicators, pressure relief device, and fault pressure relay, if applicable. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.20.3.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Perform as-left tests. 10. Verify correct liquid level in all tanks and bushings. 11. Verify that positive pressure is maintained on nitrogen-blanketed reactors. 12. Perform specific inspections and mechanical tests as recommended by the manufacturer. 13. Verify that tap connections are as specified, if applicable. * Optional Page 179 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.2 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Liquid-Filled (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.20.3.2.1. 2. Perform winding-to-ground insulation-resistance tests. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Calculate polarization index. 3. Perform insulation power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on windings in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 4. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests shall be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 5. Measure winding resistance. 6. Measure the percentage of oxygen in the nitrogen gas blanket, if applicable. 7. Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D-923. Sample shall be tested for the following: 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D-877 2. Acid neutralization number: ASTM D-974 3. Specific gravity: ASTM D-1298 4. Interfacial tension: ASTM D-971 or ASTM D-2285 5. Color: ASTM D-1500 6. Visual Condition: ASTM D-1524 7. Water in insulating liquids: ASTM D-1533 (Required on 25 kV or higher voltages and on all silicone-filled units) *8. 8. Measure power factor or dissipation factor in accordance with ASTM D-924 Remove a sample of insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D-3613 and perform dissolved-gas-analysis (DGA) in accordance with ANSI/IEEE C57.104 or ASTM D-3612. * Optional Page 180 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.2 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Liquid-Filled (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Operation of temperature devices should be in accordance with system requirements. (7.20.3.2.1.5) 2. Operation of pumps and fans should be in accordance with manufacturer’s recommendations and system design. (7.20.3.2.1.6) 3. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.20.3.2.1.8.1) 4. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.20.3.2.1.8.2) 5. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.20.3.2.1.8.3) 6. Liquid levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s indicated tolerances. (7.20.3.2.1.10) 7. Positive pressure should be indicated on the pressure gauge for gas-blanketed reactors. (7.20.3.2.1.11) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. The polarization index should be greater than 1.0 and should be compared to previous data. 3. Maximum power-factor or dissipation-factor values of liquid-filled reactors should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data, compare to test equipment manufacturer’s published data. Representative values are indicated in Table 100.3. 4. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. * Optional Page 181 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.20.3.2 Capacitors and Reactors, Reactors (Shunt and Current-Limiting), Liquid-Filled (continued) 5. Consult the manufacturer if winding-resistance values vary more than one percent from factory tests. 6. Investigate presence of oxygen in the nitrogen gas blanket. 7. Insulating liquid values should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 8. Evaluate results of dissolved-gas analysis in accordance with IEEE Standard C57.104. Compare results to previous test data. * Optional Page 182 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.21 Outdoor Bus Structures 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.21.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 6. Clean the insulators. 7. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.21.1. *2. Measure insulation resistance of each bus, phase-to-ground with other phases grounded. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform dielectric withstand voltage test on each bus phase, phase-to-ground with other phases grounded in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s data use Table 100.19. Test duration shall be for one minute. * Optional Page 183 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.21 Outdoor Bus Structures (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.21.1.5.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.21.1.5.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.21.1.5.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.1. 3. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. * Optional Page 184 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.1 Emergency Systems, Engine Generator NOTE: The prime mover is not addressed in these specifications. 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform as-left tests. Electrical and Mechanical Tests 1. Perform an insulation-resistance test on the generator winding-to-ground in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. Calculate the polarization index. 2. Test protective relay devices in accordance with Section 7.9. 3. Functionally test engine shutdown for low oil pressure, overtemperature, overspeed, and other protection features as applicable. *4. Perform vibration test for each main bearing cap. 5. Conduct performance test in accordance with ANSI/NFPA Standard 110. 6. Verify correct functioning of governor and regulator. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Anchorage, alignment, and grounding should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and system design. * Optional Page 185 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.1 Emergency Systems, Engine Generator (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Insulation resistance values should be in accordance with ANSI/IEEE Standard 43. 2. The dielectric absorption ratio or polarization shall be compared to previously obtained results and should not be less than 1.0. The recommended minimum insulation resistance (IR 1 min) test results in megohms should be corrected to 40° C and read as follows: 1. IR 1 min = kV + 1 for most windings made before 1970, all field windings, and others not described in 2.2 and 2.3. (kV is the rated machine terminal-to-terminal voltage, in rms kV) 2. IR 1 min = 100 megohms for most dc armature and ac windings built after 1970 (formwound coils). 3. IR 1 min = 5 megohms for most machines and random-wound stator coils and formwound coils rated below 1 kV. NOTE: Dielectric withstand voltage high-potential, and surge comparison tests shall not be performed on machines having values lower than those indicated above. 3. Protective relay device test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.9. 4. Low oil pressure, overtemperature, overspeed, and other protection features should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s and system design requirements. 5. Vibration levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data and shall be compared to baseline data. 6. Performance tests should conform to manufacturer’s published data and ANSI/NFPA Standard 110. 7. Governor and regulator should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s and system design requirements. * Optional Page 186 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.2 Emergency Systems, Uninterruptible Power Systems NOTE: There are many configurations of uninterruptible power supply installations. Some are as simple as a static switch selecting between two highly reliable sources, while others are complex systems using a combination of rectifiers, batteries, inverters, motor/generators, static switches and bypass switches. It is the intent of these specifications to list possible tests and maintenance of the major components of the system and more specifically the system as a whole. It is important that the manufacturer’s recommended maintenance be performed. 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Check for anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Verify that fuse sizes and types correspond to drawings. 4. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests, if required. 5. Clean the unit. 6. Test all electrical and mechanical interlock systems for correct operation and sequencing. 7. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.22.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 8. Perform as-left tests. 9. Check operation of forced ventilation. 10. Verify that filters are in place and/or vents are clear. * Optional Page 187 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.2 Emergency Systems, Uninterruptible Power Systems (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.22.2.1. 2. Test static transfer from inverter to bypass and back. Use normal load, if possible. 3. Set free running frequency of oscillator. 4. Test dc undervoltage trip level on inverter input breaker. Set according to manufacturer’s published data. 5. Test alarm circuits. 6. Verify sync indicators for static switch and bypass switches. 7. Perform electrical tests for UPS system breakers in accordance with Section 7.6.1. 8. Perform electrical tests for UPS system automatic transfer switches in accordance with Section 7.22.3. 9. Perform electrical tests for UPS system batteries in accordance with Section 7.18. 10. Perform electrical tests for UPS rotating machinery in accordance with Section 7.15. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 1. Electrical and mechanical interlock systems should operate in accordance with system design requirements. (7.22.2.1.6) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.22.2.1.7.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.22.2.1.7.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.22.2.1.7.3) * Optional Page 188 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.2 Emergency Systems, Uninterruptible Power Systems (continued) 3.2 Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Static transfer should function in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 3. Oscillator free running frequency should be within manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. 4. DC undervoltage should trip inverter input breaker. 5. Alarm circuits should operate in accordance with design requirements. 6. Sync indicators should operate in accordance with design requirements. 7. Breaker performance shall be in accordance with Section 7.6.1 8. Automatic transfer switch performance shall be in accordance with Section 7.22.3. 9. Battery test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.18. 10. Rotating machinery performance shall be in accordance with Section 7.15. * Optional Page 189 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.3 Emergency Systems, Automatic Transfer Switches 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, grounding, and required clearances. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Use appropriate lubrication on moving current-carrying parts and on moving and sliding surfaces. 6. Verify that manual transfer warnings are attached and visible. 7. Verify tightness of all control connections. 8. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 9. 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.22.3.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. Perform manual transfer operation. 10. Verify positive mechanical interlocking between normal and alternate sources. 11. Perform as-left tests. * Optional Page 190 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.3 Emergency Systems, Automatic Transfer Switches (continued) 2. Electrical Tests 1. *2. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.22.3.1. Perform insulation resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components or for control devices that cannot tolerate the applied voltage, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 4. Verify settings and operation of control devices. 5. Calibrate and set all relays and timers in accordance with Section 7.9. 6. Perform automatic transfer tests: 7. 1. Simulate loss of normal power. 2. Return to normal power. 3. Simulate loss of emergency power. 4. Simulate all forms of single-phase conditions. Verify correct operation and timing of the following functions: 1. Normal source voltage-sensing and frequency sensing relays. 2. Engine start sequence. 3. Time delay upon transfer. 4. Alternate source voltage-sensing and frequency sensing relays. 5. Automatic transfer operation. 6. Interlocks and limit switch function. 7. Time delay and retransfer upon normal power restoration. 8. Engine cool down and shutdown feature. * Optional Page 191 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.22.3 Emergency Systems, Automatic Transfer Switches (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.22.3.1.8.1) 2. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.22.3.1.8.2) 3. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.22.3.1.8.3) Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two meghoms. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Control devices should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 5. Relay test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.9. 6. Automatic transfers should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s design. 7. Operation and timing should be in accordance with manufacturer’s and/or system design requirements. * Optional Page 192 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. 7.23 INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES Communications – RESERVED – * Optional Page 193 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.1 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform all mechanical operation and contact alignment tests on both the recloser and its operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.24.1.2.1. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 7. Inspect for correct insulating liquid level, if applicable. 8. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.24.1.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with recloser closed and across each pole with the recloser open. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. *4. Perform insulation-resistance tests on all control wiring with respect to ground. The applied potential shall be 500 volts dc for 300-volt rated cable and 1000 volts dc for 600-volt rated cable. Test duration shall be one minute. For units with solid-state components, follow manufacturer’s recommendation. * Optional Page 194 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.1 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum (continued) 5. Remove a sample of insulating liquid, if applicable, in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 and/or ASTM D 1816 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 *6. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils in accordance with Table 100.20. *7. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each pole with the recloser open and each phase with the recloser closed. *8. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests should be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 9. Perform vacuum bottle integrity test (dielectric withstand voltage), if applicable, across each vacuum bottle with the recloser in the open position in strict accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 10. Perform dielectric withstand voltage test on each phase with the recloser closed and the poles not under test grounded. Test voltage should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.19. 11. Verify operation of heaters, if applicable. 12. Test all protective functions in accordance with Section 7.9. 13. Test all metering and instrumentation in accordance with Section 7.11. 14. Test instrument transformers in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 195 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.1 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum (continued) 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Mechanical operation and contact alignment should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.24.1.1.5) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.24.1.1.6.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.24.1.1.6.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.24.1.1.6.3) 5. Insulating liquid level should be in accordance with manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar reclosers by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulation-resistance values of control wiring should be comparable to previously obtained results but not less than two megohms. 5. Insulating liquid test results should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 6. Minimum pickup for trip and close coils should conform with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data refer to Table 100.20. * Optional Page 196 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.1 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum (continued) 7. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values and tank loss index shall be compared to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, the comparison shall be made to test data from similar circuit reclosers or sectionalizers or data from test equipment manufacturers. 8. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. 9. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the vacuum bottle integrity test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test 10. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 11. Heaters should be operational. 12. Protective device function test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.9. 13. Metering and instrumentation test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.11. 14. Instrument transformer test results shall be in accordance with Section 7.10. * Optional Page 197 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.2 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Line Sectionalizers, Oil 1. 2. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Inspect anchorage, alignment, and grounding. 3. Prior to cleaning the unit, perform as-found tests. 4. Clean the unit. 5. Perform all mechanical operation and contact alignment tests on both the sectionalizer and its operating mechanism in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 6. Inspect bolted electrical connections for high resistance using one or more of the following methods: 1. Use of a low-resistance ohmmeter in accordance with Section 7.24.2.2. 2. Verify tightness of accessible bolted electrical connections by calibrated torque-wrench method in accordance with manufacturer’s published data or Table 100.12. 3. Perform a thermographic survey in accordance with Section 9. 7. Inspect for correct insulating liquid level. 8. Perform as-left tests. Electrical Tests 1. Perform resistance measurements through bolted connections with a low-resistance ohmmeter, if applicable, in accordance with Section 7.24.2.1. 2. Perform insulation-resistance tests for one minute on each pole, phase-to-phase and phase-toground with sectionalizer closed and across each open pole. Apply voltage in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. 3. Perform a contact/pole-resistance test. 4. Remove a sample insulating liquid in accordance with ASTM D 923. Sample shall be tested in accordance with the referenced standard. 1. Dielectric breakdown voltage: ASTM D 877 2. Color: ANSI/ASTM D 1500 * Optional Page 198 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.2 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Line Sectionalizers, Oil (continued) 3. Visual condition: ASTM D 1524 5. Perform dielectric withstand voltage tests on each pole-to-ground and pole-to-pole. 6. Test sectionalizer counting function by application of simulated fault current (greater than 160 percent of continuous current rating). 7. Test sectionalizer lockout function for all counting positions. 8. Test for reset timing on trip actuator. *9. * 10. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each pole with the recloser open and each phase with the recloser closed. Perform power-factor or dissipation-factor tests on each bushing equipped with a power-factor/ capacitance tap. In the absence of a power-factor/ capacitance tap, perform hot-collar tests. These tests should be in accordance with the test equipment manufacturer’s published data. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Mechanical operation and contact alignment should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. (7.24.2.1.5) 2. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. (7.24.2.1.6.1) 3. Bolt-torque levels should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.12. (7.24.2.1.6.2) 4. Results of the thermographic survey shall be in accordance with Section 9. (7.24.2.1.6.3) 5. Insulating liquid level should be in accordance with manufacturer’s recommended tolerances. Test Values – Electrical 1. Compare bolted connection resistance values to values of similar connections. Investigate values which deviate from those of similar bolted connections by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. * Optional Page 199 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES 7.24.2 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers, Automatic Line Sectionalizers, Oil (continued) 2. Insulation-resistance values should be in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, use Table 100.1. Values of insulation resistance less than this table or manufacturer’s recommendations should be investigated. 3. Microhm or dc millivolt drop values should not exceed the high levels of the normal range as indicated in the manufacturer’s published data. If manufacturer’s data is not available, investigate values that deviate from adjacent poles or similar switches by more than 50 percent of the lowest value. 4. Insulating liquid test results should be in accordance with Table 100.4. 5. If no evidence of distress or insulation failure is observed by the end of the total time of voltage application during the dielectric withstand voltage test, the test specimen is considered to have passed the test. 6. Operations counter should advance one digit per close-open cycle. 7. Lockout function should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 8. Reset timing of trip actuator should operate in accordance with manufacturer’s published data. 9. Power-factor or dissipation-factor values and tank loss index shall be compared to manufacturer’s published data. In the absence of manufacturer’s published data, the comparison shall be made to test data from similar circuit reclosers or sectionalizers or data from test equipment manufacturers. 10. Power-factor or dissipation-factor and capacitance values should be within ten percent of nameplate rating for bushings. Hot collar tests are evaluated on a milliampere/milliwatt loss basis, and the results should be compared to values of similar bushings. * Optional Page 200 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 7. 7.25 1. 2. INSPECTION AND TEST PROCEDURES Fiber-Optic Cables Visual and Mechanical Inspection 1. Inspect cable and connections for physical and mechanical damage. 2. Verify that all connectors and splices are correctly installed. Optical Tests 1. Perform cable length measurement, fiber fracture inspection, and construction defect inspection using an optical time domain reflectometer. 2. Perform connector and splice integrity test using an optical time domain reflectometer. 3. Perform cable attenuation loss measurement with an optical power loss test set. 4. Perform connector and splice attenuation loss measurement from both ends of the optical cable with an optical power loss test set. 3. Test Values 3.1 Test Values – Visual and Mechanical 3.2 1. Cable and connections should not have been subjected to physical or mechanical damage. (7.25.1.1) 2. Connectors and splices should be installed in accordance with industry standards. (7.25.1.2) Test Values – Optical 1. The optical time domain reflectometer signal should be analyzed for excessive connection, splice, or cable backscatter by viewing the reflected power/distance graph. 2. The optical time domain reflectometer signal should be analyzed for excessive connection, splice, or cable backscatter by viewing the reflected power/distance graph. 3. Attenuation loss measurement shall be expressed in dB/km. Losses should be within the manufacturer’s recommendations when no local site specifications are available. 4. Attenuation loss measurement shall be expressed in dB/km. Losses should be within the manufacturer’s recommendations when no local site specifications are available. * Optional Page 201 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 8. SYSTEM FUNCTION TESTS It is the purpose of system function tests to prove the correct interaction of all sensing, processing, and action devices. Perform system function tests upon completion of the maintenance tests defined, as system conditions allow. 1. Develop test parameters and perform tests for the purpose of evaluating performance of all integral components and their functioning as a complete unit within design requirements and manufacturer’s published data. 2. Verify the correct operation of all interlock safety devices for fail-safe functions in addition to design function. 3. Verify the correct operation of all sensing devices, alarms, and indicating devices. Page 202 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 9. THERMOGRAPHIC SURVEY 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 2. 1. Inspect physical and mechanical condition. 2. Remove panel covers or view the equipment through viewing ports designed to transmit applicable signals being measured. Thermographic Survey Report Provide a report which includes the following: 3. 4. 1. Description of equipment to be tested. 2. Discrepancies. 3. Temperature difference between the area of concern and the reference area. 4. Probable cause of temperature difference. 5. Areas inspected. Identify inaccessible and/or unobservable areas and/or equipment. 6. Identify load conditions at time of inspection. 7. Provide photographs and/or thermograms of the deficient area. 8. Provide recommended action for repair. Test Parameters 1. Inspect distribution systems with imaging equipment capable of detecting a minimum temperature difference of 1° C at 30° C. 2. Equipment shall detect emitted radiation and convert detected radiation to visual signal. 3. Thermographic surveys should be performed during periods of maximum possible loading. Refer to ANSI/NFPA 70B 2006 edition, Section 21.17 Test Results Suggested actions based on temperature rise can be found in Table 100.18. Page 203 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 10. ELECTROMAGNETIC FIELD SURVEY 1. Procedure 1. 1. Take detailed measurements of the magnetic flux density, vector direction, and temporal variations at the locations or over the area, as necessary. 1. Perform spot measurements of the magnetic fields (40 to 800 hertz) at grid intervals one meter above the floor throughout the office. Record x, y, z, and resultant magnetic flux density values for each measurement point. 2. Take additional detailed spot measurements directly at floor level, at two meters above the floor, at grid point locations, and directly on the wall surface separating the measured area from suspected magnetic field source. 3. If measured magnetic flux densities at any perimeter wall appear to be above 3.0 mG, take additional spot measurements of the adjoining space utilizing the same measurement grid spacing at a height of one meter above floor. 4. Take a baseline magnetic flux density reading at a specific point in the immediate area of the suspected magnetic field source. 5. Determine magnetic field temporal variations as required by positioning the Gaussmeter at or near the location of highest magnetic flux density for 24 to 48 hours. 2. Obtain and record electrical system information including current measurements. 3. The magnetic field evaluation shall be performed in accordance with the recommended practices and procedures in accordance with IEEE 644. Survey Report Provide a report which includes the following: 1. Basis, description, purpose, and scope of the survey. 2. Tabulations and or attached graphical representations of the magnetic flux density measurements corresponding to the time and area or space where the measurements were taken. 3. Descriptions of each of the operating conditions evaluated and identification of the condition that resulted in the highest magnetic flux density. 4. Descriptions of equipment performance issues that could be related to measured magnetic flux density. 5. Description of magnetic field test equipment. 6. Conclusions and recommendations. Page 204 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 11.0 CORONA STUDIES – RESERVED – Page 205 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – Page 206 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Tables Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems TABLE 100.1 Insulation Resistance Test Values Electrical Apparatus and Systems Nominal Rating of Equipment (Volts) Recommended Minimum Minimum Test Voltage Insulation Resistance (DC) (Megohms) 250 500 25 600 1,000 100 1,000 1,000 100 2,500 1,000 500 5,000 2,500 1,000 8,000 2,500 2,000 15,000 2,500 5,000 25,000 5,000 20,000 34,500 and above 15,000 100,000 In the absence of consensus standards dealing with insulation-resistance tests, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. See Table 100.14 for temperature correction factors. Test results are dependent on the temperature of the insulating material and the humidity of the surrounding environment at the time of the test. Insulation-resistance test data may be used to establish a trending pattern. Deviations from the baseline information permit evaluation of the insulation. Page 208 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.2 Switchgear Withstand Test Voltages Type of Switchgear Low-Voltage Power Circuit Breaker Switchgear Metal-Clad Switchgear Station-Type Cubicle Switchgear Metal-Enclosed Interrupter Switchgear Rated Maximum Voltage (kV) (rms) Maximum Test Voltage (kV) AC DC 1.6 2.3 .254/.508/.635 4.76 14 20 8.25 27 37 15.0 27 37 27.0 45 a 38.0 60 a 15.5 37 a 38.0 60 a 72.5 120 a 4.76 14 20 8.25 19 27 15.0 27 37 27 45 a 38.0 60 a Derived from ANSI/IEEE C37.20.1-1993 Standard for Metal-Enclosed Low-Voltage Power Circuit-Breaker Switchgear, Paragraph 5; ANSI/IEEE C37.20.2-1999, Standard for Metal-Clad Switchgear, Paragraph 6.5; and ANSI/IEEE C37.20.32001 Standard for Metal-Enclosed Interrupter Switchgear, Paragraph 6.5. This table includes 0.75 multiplier with fraction rounded down. The column headed “DC” is given as a reference only for those using dc tests to verify the integrity of connected cable installations without disconnecting the cables from the switchgear. It represents values believed to be appropriate and approximately equivalent to the corresponding power frequency withstand test values specified for voltage rating of switchgear. The presence of this column in no way implies any requirement for a dc withstand test on ac equipment or that a dc withstand test represents an acceptable alternative to the low-frequency withstand tests specified in these specifications, either for design tests, production tests, conformance tests, or field tests. When making dc tests, the voltage should be raised to the test value in discrete steps and held for a period of one minute. a. Because of the variable voltage distribution encountered when making dc withstand tests, the manufacturer should be contacted for recommendations before applying dc withstand tests to the switchgear. Voltage transformers above 34.5 kV should be disconnected when testing with dc. Refer to ANSI/IEEE C57.13-1993 (IEEE Standard Requirements for Instrument Transformers) paragraph 8.8.2. Page 209 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.3 Maintenance Test Values Recommended Dissipation Factor/Power Factor at 20 C Liquid-Filled Transformers, Regulators, and Reactors Oil Maximum Silicone Maximum Tetrachloroethylene Maximum High Fire Point Hydrocarbon Maximum Power Transformers 1.0% 0.5% 3.0% 2.0% Distribution Transformers 2.0% 0.5% 3.0% 3.0% In the absence of consensus standards dealing with transformer dissipation/power factor values, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. Maximum values for oil are based on data from Doble Engineering Company. Page 210 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.4.1 Suggested Limits for Class I Insulating Oil Mineral Oil a Test ASTM Method 69 kV and Below Acceptable Values Above 69 kV 230 kV and Below 230 kV Above Dielectric breakdown, kV minimum b D 877 26 26 26 Dielectric breakdown, kV minimum @ 1 mm (0.04 inch) gap D 1816 23 28 30 Dielectric breakdown, kV minimum @ 2 mm (0.08 inch) gap D 1816 40 47 50 Interfacial tension mN/m minimum D 971 or D 2285 25 30 32 Neutralization number, mg KOH/g maximum D 974 0.20 0.15 0.10 Water content, ppm maximum @ 60º C c D 1533 35 25 20 Power factor at 25° C, % D 924 0.5 0.5 0.5 Power factor at 100° C, % D 924 5.0 5.0 5.0 D 1500 3.5 3.5 3.5 Visual Condition D 1524 Bright, clear and free of particles Specific Gravity (Relative Density) @ 15º C Maximum e D 1298 0.91 Color a. b. c. d. e. d Bright, clear and free of particles 0.91 Bright, clear and free of particles 0.91 ANSI/IEEE C57.106-2002 Guide for Acceptance and Maintenance of Insulating Oil in Equipment, Table 7. IEEE STD 637-1985 Guide for Reclamation of Insulating Oil and Criteria for Its Use, Table 1. ANSI/IEEE C57.106-2002 Guide for Acceptance and Maintenance of Insulating Oil in Equipment, Table 5. In the absence of consensus standards, NETA’s Standard Review Council suggests these values. ANSI/IEEE C57.106 Guide for Acceptance and Maintenance of Insulating Oil in Equipment, Table 1. Page 211 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.4.2 Suggested Limits for Less-Flammable Hydrocarbon Insulating Liquid Test ASTM Method Acceptable Values Dielectric breakdown voltage, kV minimum D 877 24 Dielectric breakdown voltage for 1 mm (0.04 inch) gap, kV minimum D 1816 34 Dielectric breakdown voltage for 2 mm (0.08 inch) gap, kV minimum D 1816 24 Water content, ppm maximum D 1533 B 35 Dissipation/power factor, 60 hertz, % max. @ 25° C D 924 1.0 Fire point, ° C, minimum D 92 300 Interfacial tension, mN/m, 25° C D 971 24 Neutralization number, mg KOH/g D 664 0.20 ANSI/IEEE C57.121-1998 Guide for Acceptance and Maintenance of Less-Flammable Hydrocarbon Fluid in Transformers, Table 4. The values in this table are considered typical for acceptable service-aged LFH fluids as a general class. If actual test analysis approaches the values shown, consult the fluid manufacturer for specific recommendations. If the purpose of the HMWH installation is to comply with the NFPA 70 National Electrical Code, this value is the minimum for compliance with NEC Article 450.23. Page 212 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.4.3 Suggested Limits for Service-Aged Silicone Insulating Liquid Test ASTM Method Acceptable Values Dielectric breakdown, kV minimum D 877 25 Visual D 2129 Colorless, clear, free of particles Water content, ppm maximum D 1533 100 Dissipation/power factor, 60 hertz, maximum @ 25° C D 924 0.2 Viscosity, cSt @ 25° C D 445 47.5 – 52.5 Fire point, ° C, minimum D 92 340 Neutralization number, mg KOH/g max. D 974 0.2 ANSI/IEEE C57.111-1989 (R1995) Guide for Acceptance of Silicone Insulating Fluid and Its Maintenance in Transformers, Table 3. TABLE 100.4.4 Suggested Limits for Service-Aged Tetrachloroethylene Insulating Fluid Test ASTM Method Acceptable Values Dielectric breakdown, kV minimum D 877 26 Visual D 2129 Clear with purple iridescence Water content, ppm maximum D 1533 35 Dissipation/power factor, % maximum @ 25° C D 924 12.0 Viscosity, cSt @ 25° C D 445 0 Fire point, ° C, minimum D 92 - Neutralization number, mg KOH/g maximum D 974 0.25 Neutralization number, mg KOH/g maximum D 664 - Interfacial tension, mN/m minimum @ 25º C D 971 - Instruction Book PC-2000 for WecosolTM Fluid-Filled Primary and Secondary Unit Substation Transformers, ABB Power T&D. Page 213 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.5 Transformer Insulation Resistance Maintenance Testing Recommended Minimum Insulation Resistance (Megohms) Transformer Coil Rating Type (Volts) Minimum DC Test Voltage Liquid Filled Dry 0 – 600 1000 100 500 601 – 5000 2500 1000 5000 Greater than 5000 5000 5000 25000 In the absence of consensus standards, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. See Table 100.14 for temperature correction factors. NOTE: Since insulation resistance depends on insulation rating (kV) and winding capacity (kVA), values obtained should be compared to manufacturer’s published data. Page 214 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.6.1 Medium-Voltage Cables Maintenance Test Values DC Test Voltages Rated Voltage Phase-toPhase (kV) Conductor Size AWG or kcmil (mm) Nominal Insulation Thickness mils (mm) 100% 133% Insulation Insulation Level Level Maximum DC Field Test Voltages (kV) First 5 Years After Installation 100% 133% Insulation Insulation Level Level 5 8-1000 (8.4-507) Above 1000 (507) 90 (2.29) 140 (3.56) 115 (2.92) 140 (3.56) 9 9 11 11 8 6-1000 (13.3-507) Above 1000 (507) 115 (2.92) 175 (4.45) 140 (3.56) 175 (4.45) 11 11 14 14 15 2-1000 (33.6-507) Above 1000 (507) 175 (4.45) 220 (5.59) 220 (5.59) 220 (5.59) 18 18 20 20 25 1-2000 (42.4-1013) 260 (6.60) 320 (8.13) 25 30 28 1-2000 (42.4-1013) 280 (7.11) 345 (8.76) 26 31 35 1/0-2000 (53.5-1013) 345 (8.76) 420 (10.7) 31 39 46 4/0-2000 (107.2-1013) 445 (11.3) 580 (14.7) 41 54 Reproduction of tables from ICEA S-94-649-2004 Standard for Concentric Neutral Cables Rated 5,000 – 46,000 Volts and ICEA S-97-682-2007 Utility Shielded Power Cables Rated 5,000 – 46,000 Volts. Page 215 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.6.2 Field Test Voltages for Laminated Dielectric, Shielded Power Cable Systems Rated 5,000 Volts and Above with High DC Voltage System voltage, kV rms, phase-to-phase System BIL, kV crest Maintenance test, kV dc, phase-to-ground 5 8 15 25 28 35 46 69 115 115 138 161 230 345 345 500 500 500 75 95 110 150 170 200 250 350 450 550 650 750 1050 1175 1300 1425 1550 1675 23 29 46 61 68 75 95 130 170 205 245 280 395 440 488 535 580 629 NOTE 1 – Voltages higher than those listed, up to 80% of system BIL, may be considered, but the age and operating environment of the system should be taken into account. The user is urged to consult the suppliers of the cable and any/all accessories before applying the high voltage. NOTE 2 – When older cables or other types/classes of cables or other equipment, such as transformers, switchgear, motors, etc. are connected to the cable to be tested, voltages lower than those shown in this table may be necessary to comply with the limitations imposed by such interconnected cables and equipment. See IEEE Std 95 TM [B5]7 and Table 1 of IEEE Std C37.20.2TM1999 [B7]. NOTE 3 – If the test voltage exceeds 50% of system BIL, surge protection against excessive overvoltages induced by flashovers at the termination should be provided. NOTE 4 – It is strongly recommended that the user consult with the manufacturer(s) of all components that will be subjected to such testing before performing any tests on cables and cable accessories rated 115 kV and higher. NOTE 5 – It should be noted that this table and the test procedures suggested in this guide do not necessarily agree with the recommendations of other organizations, such as those of the Association of Edison Illuminating Companies [B1], [B2], [B3], [B4]. Where there is concern, a user should consult the supplier of the cable and accessories to ascertain that the components will withstand the test. Reproduction of table from IEEE Std 400.1-2007 IEEE Guide for Field Testing of Laminated Dielectric, Shielded Power Cable Systems Rated 5 kV and Above with High Direct Current Voltage. Page 216 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.6.3 Very Low Frequency Testing Levels for Medium-Voltage Cable 0.1 Hz Test Voltage (rms) Very Low Frequency Testing Levels 0.1 Hz Test Voltage (rms) System Voltage Maintenance Phase-to-Phase Phase-to-Ground (kV) (rms) (kV) (rms) 5 8 15 25 35 7 10 16 23 33 Adaptation of table from IEEE Std 400.2-2004 Guide for field testing of shielded power cable systems using very low frequency (VLF). Page 217 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.7 Molded-Case Circuit Breakers Inverse Time Trip Test (At 300% of Rated Continuous Current of Circuit Breaker) Maximum Trip Time in Seconds for Each Maximum Frame Rating a Range of Rated Continuous Current (Amperes) < 250 V 251 – 600 V 0-30 50 70 31-50 80 100 51-100 140 160 101-150 200 250 151-225 230 275 226-400 300 350 401-600 ----- 450 601-800 ----- 500 801-1000 ----- 600 1001 – 1200 ----- 700 1201-1600 ----- 775 1601-2000 ----- 800 2001-2500 ----- 850 2501-5000 ----- 900 6000 ----- 1000 Derived from Table 5-3, NEMA Standard AB 4-2000, Guidelines for Inspection and Preventative Maintenance of Molded-Case Circuit Breaker Used in Commercial and Industrial Applications. a. Trip times may be substantially longer for integrally-fused circuit breakers if tested with the fuses replaced by solid links (shorting bars). Page 218 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.8 Instantaneous Trip Tolerances for Field Testing of Circuit Breakers Tolerances of Manufacturer’s Published Trip Range Breaker Type Tolerance of Settings High Side Low Side Electronic Trip Units (1) +30% ----- ----- Adjustable (1) +40% ----- ----- +25% -25% -30% Nonadjustable (2) ----- NEMA AB4-2009 Guidelines for Inspection and Preventative Maintenance of Molded-Case Circuit Breaker Used in Commercial and Industrial Applications, Table 4. 1. Tolerances are based on variations from the nominal settings. 2. Tolerances are based on variations from the manufacturer’s published trip band (i.e., -25% below the low side of the band; +25% above the high side of the band.) Page 219 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.9 Instrument Transformer Dielectric Tests Field Maintenance Nominal System (kV) BIL (kV) Periodic Dielectric Withstand Test Field Test Voltage (kV) AC DC b 0.6 10 2.6 4 1.1 30 6.5 10 2.4 45 9.7 15 4.8 60 12.3 19 8.32 75 16.9 26 13.8 95 22.1 34 13.8 110 22.1 34 25 125 26.0 40 25 150 32.5 50 34.5 150 32.5 50 34.5 200 45.5 70 46 250 61.7 a 69 350 91.0 a 115 450 120.0 a 115 550 149.0 a 138 550 149.0 a 138 650 178.0 a 161 650 178.0 a 161 750 211.0 a 230 900 256.0 a 230 1050 299.0 a Table is derived from Paragraph 8.8.2 and Tables 2 and 7 of ANSI/IEEE C57.13-1993, Standard Requirements for Instrument Transformers. a. Periodic dc potential tests are not recommended for transformers rated higher than 34.5 kV. b. Under some conditions transformers may be subjected to periodic insulation test using direct voltage. In such cases the test direct voltage should not exceed the original factory test rms alternating voltage. Periodic direct-voltage tests should not be applied to (instrument) transformers of higher than 34.5 kV voltage rating. Page 220 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.10 Maximum Allowable Vibration Amplitude RPM (at 60 Hz) Velocity (in/s peak) Velocity (mm/s) RPM (at 50 Hz) Velocity (in/s peak) Velocity (mm/s) 3600 0.15 3.8 3000 0.15 3.8 1800 0.15 3.8 1500 0.15 3.8 1200 0.15 3.8 1000 0.13 3.3 900 0.12 3.0 750 0.10 2.5 720 0.09 2.3 600 0.08 2.0 600 0.08 2.0 500 0.07 1.7 Derived from NEMA MG 1-7.08, Table 7-1. Table is unfiltered vibration limits for resiliently mounted machines. For machines with rigid mounting multiply the limiting values by 0.8. Page 221 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.11 – WITHDRAWN – Page 222 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.12.1 Bolt-Torque Values for Electrical Connections US Standard Fasteners a Heat-Treated Steel – Cadmium or Zinc Plated b Grade SAE 1&2 SAE 5 SAE 7 SAE 8 64K 105K 133K 150K Head Marking Minimum Tensile (Strength) (lbf/in2) Bolt Diameter (Inches) a. b. Torque (Pound-Feet) 1/4 4 6 8 8 5/16 7 11 15 18 3/8 12 20 27 30 7/16 19 32 44 48 1/2 30 48 68 74 9/16 42 70 96 105 5/8 59 96 135 145 3/4 96 160 225 235 7/8 150 240 350 380 1.0 225 370 530 570 Consult manufacturer for equipment supplied with metric fasteners. Table is based on national coarse thread pitch. Table 100.12.2 US Standard Fasteners a Silicon Bronze Fasteners b c Torque (Pound-Feet) Bolt Diameter (Inches) 5/16 3/8 1/2 5/8 3/4 a. b. c. Nonlubricated 15 20 40 55 70 Lubricated 10 15 25 40 60 Consult manufacturer for equipment supplied with metric fasteners. Table is based on national coarse thread pitch. This table is based on bronze alloy bolts having a minimum tensile strength of 70,000 pounds per square inch. Page 223 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.12.3 US Standard Fasteners a Aluminum Alloy Fasteners b c Torque (Pound-Feet) a. b. c. Bolt Diameter (Inches) Lubricated 5/16 10 3/8 14 1/2 25 5/8 40 3/4 60 Consult manufacturer for equipment supplied with metric fasteners. Table is based on national coarse thread pitch. This table is based on aluminum alloy bolts having a minimum tensile strength of 55,000 pounds per square inch. TABLE 100.12.4 US Standard Fasteners a Stainless Steel Fasteners b c Torque (Pound-Feet) a. b. c. Bolt Diameter (Inches) Uncoated 5/16 15 3/8 20 1/2 40 5/8 55 3/4 70 Consult manufacturer for equipment supplied with metric fasteners. Table is based on national coarse thread pitch. This table is to be used for the following hardware types: Bolts, cap screws, nuts, flat washers, locknuts (18-8 alloy) Belleville washers (302 alloy). Tables in 100.12 are compiled from Penn-Union Catalogue and Square D Company, Anderson Products Division, General Catalog: Class 3910 Distribution Technical Data, Class 3930 Reference Data Substation Connector Products. Page 224 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.13 SF6 Gas Tests Test Method Serviceability Limits a Moisture Hygrometer SF6 decomposition byproducts ASTM D 2685 500 ppm Air ASTM D 2685 5000 ppm c Dielectric breakdown hemispherical contacts 2.54 mm (0.10 inch) gap at atmospheric pressure a. b. c. d. Per manufacturer or 200 ppm b 11.5 – 13.5 kV d In the absence of consensus standards dealing with SF6 circuit breaker gas tests, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. According to some manufacturers. Dominelli, N. and Wylie, L., Analysis of SF6 Gas as a Diagnostic Technique for GIS, Electric Power Research Institute, Substation Equipment Diagnostics Conference IV, February 1996. Per Even, F.E., and Mani, G. Sulfur Fluorides, Kirk, Othmer Encyclopedia of Chemical Technology, 4th ed., 11,428, 1994. Reference: IEC 61634 High-Voltage Switchgear and Controlgear – Use and Handling of Sulfur Hexafluoride (SF6) in High-Voltage Switchgear and Controlgear. Page 225 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.14.1 Insulation Resistance Conversion Factors (20° C) Temperature Multiplier Apparatus Containing Oil Immersed Apparatus Containing Insulation Solid Insulation °C °F -10 14 0.125 0.25 -5 23 0.180 0.32 0 32 0.25 0.40 5 41 0.36 0.50 10 50 0.50 0.63 15 59 0.75 0.81 20 68 1.00 1.00 25 77 1.40 1.25 30 86 1.98 1.58 35 95 2.80 2.00 40 104 3.95 2.50 45 113 5.60 3.15 50 122 7.85 3.98 55 131 11.20 5.00 60 140 15.85 6.30 65 149 22.40 7.90 70 158 31.75 10.00 75 167 44.70 12.60 80 176 63.50 15.80 85 185 89.789 20.00 90 194 127.00 25.20 95 203 180.00 31.60 100 212 254.00 40.00 105 221 359.15 50.40 110 230 509.00 63.20 Derived from Megger, Stitch in Time…The Complete Guide to Electrical Insulation Testing. Formula: Rc = Ra x K Where: Rc Ra K is resistance corrected to 20° C is measured resistance at test temperature is applicable multiplier Example: Resistance test on oil-immersion insulation at 104° F Ra = 2 megohms @ 104° F K = 3.95 Rc = Ra x K Rc = 2.0 x 3.95 Rc = 7.90 megohms @ 20° C Page 226 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.14.2 Insulation Resistance Conversion Factors (40° C) Temperature °C °F -10 -5 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 14 23 32 41 50 59 68 77 86 95 104 113 122 131 140 149 158 167 176 185 194 203 212 221 230 Multiplier Apparatus Containing Oil Immersed Apparatus Containing Insulation Solid Insulation 0.03 0.04 0.06 0.09 0.13 0.18 0.25 0.35 0.50 0.71 1.00 1.41 2.00 2.83 4.00 5.66 8.00 11.31 16.00 22.63 32.00 45.25 64.00 90.51 128.00 0.10 0.13 0.16 0.20 0.25 0.31 0.40 0.50 0.63 0.79 1.00 1.26 1.59 2.00 2.52 3.17 4.00 5.04 6.35 8.00 10.08 12.70 16.00 20.16 25.40 Derived from Megger, Stitch in Time…The Complete Guide to Electrical Insulation Testing and ANSI/IEEE 43-2000 IEEE Recommended Practice for Testing Insulation Resistance of Rotating Machinery . Notes: The insulation resistance coefficient is based on the halving of the insulation resistance to the change in temperature. Apparatus Containing Immersed Oil Insulation Table uses 10° C change with temperature halving. Apparatus Containing Solid Insulation Table uses 15° C change with temperature halving. Formula: Rc = Ra x K Where: Rc is resistance corrected to 40° C Ra is measured resistance at test temperature K is applicable multiplier Example: Resistance test on oil-immersion insulation at 68° F/20° C Ra = 2 megohms @ 68° F/20° C K = 0.40 Rc = Ra x K Rc = 2.0 x 0.40 = 0.8 megohms @ 40° C Page 227 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.15 High-Potential Test Voltage for Automatic Circuit Reclosers Maintenance Testing Nominal Voltage Class (kV) Maximum Voltage (kV) Rated Impulse Withstand Voltage (kV) Maximum AC a Field Test Voltage (kV) 14.4 (1ø and 3 ø) 15.0 95 26.2 14.4 (1 ø and 3 ø) 15.5 110 37.5 24.9 (1 ø and 3 ø) 27.0 150 45.0 34.5 (1 ø and 3 ø) 38.0 150 52.5 46.0 (3 ø) 48.3 250 78.7 69.0 (3 ø) 72.5 350 120.0 Derived from ANSI/IEEE C37.61-1973(R1992) Standard Guide for the Application, Operation, and Maintenance of Automatic Circuit Reclosers and from ANSI/IEEE C37.60-1981(R1992) Standard Requirements for Overhead, PadMounted, Dry-Vault, and Submersible Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Fault Interrupters for AC Systems, Table 2, Column 5. a. Derived from ANSI/IEEE C37.60-1981(R1992), Table 2, Column 5. In accordance with ANSI/IEEE C37.61, Section 6.2.2 (Servicing), a .75 multiplier has been applied to the values. Page 228 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.16 High-Potential Test Voltage for Periodic Test of Line Sectionalizers Nominal Voltage Class (kV) Maximum Voltage (kV) Rated Impulse Withstand Voltage (kV) Maximum AC Field Test Voltage (kV) 15 Minute DC Withstand (kV) 14.4 (1 ø) 15.0 95 26.2 39 14.4 (1 ø) 15.0 125 31.5 39 14.4 (3 ø) 15.5 110 37.5 39 24.9 (1 ø) 27.0 125 45.0 58 34.5 (3 ø) 38.0 150 52.5 77 Derived from ANSI/IEEE C37.63-1984(R1990) Standard Requirements for Overhead, Pad-Mounted, Dry-Vault, and Submersible Automatic Line Sectionalizers of AC Systems, Table 2. The table includes a 0.75 multiplier with fractions rounded down. In the absence of consensus standards, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. NOTE: Values of ac voltage given are dry test, one-minute, factory test values. Page 229 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.17 Metal-Enclosed Bus Dielectric Withstand Test Voltages Type of Bus Isolated Phase for Generator Leads Isolated Phase for Other than Generator Leads Rated kV 24.5 37.0 52.0 29.5 45.0 -- 34.5 60.0 -- 15.5 37.0 52.0 25.8 45.0 -- 38.0 60.0 -- 0.635 1.6 2.3 14.2 20.0 15.0 27.0 37.0 25.8 45.0 63.0 38.0 60.0 -- 15.5 37.0 52.0 25.8 45.0 63.0 38.0 60.0 -- 4.76 Nonsegregated Phase Segregated Phase DC Bus Duct a Maximum Test Voltage (kV) AC DC 0.3 1.6 2.3 0.8 2.7 3.9 1.2 3.4 4.8 1.6 4.0 5.7 3.2 6.6 9.3 Derived from ANSI-IEEE C37.23-1987 Standard for Metal-Enclosed Bus and Calculating Losses in Isolated-Phase Bus, Tables 3A, 3B, 3C, 3D and paragraph 6.4.2. The table includes a 0.75 multiplier with fractions rounded down. Note: a. The presence of the column headed “DC” does not imply any requirement for a dc withstand test on ac equipment. This column is given as a reference only for those using dc tests and represents values believed to be appropriate and approximately equivalent to the corresponding power frequency withstand test values specified for each class of bus. Direct current withstand tests are recommended for flexible bus to avoid the loss of insulation life that may result from the dielectric heating that occurs with rated frequency withstand testing. Because of the variable voltage distribution encountered when making dc withstand tests and variances in leakage currents associated with various insulation systems, the manufacturer should be consulted for recommendations before applying dc withstand tests to this equipment. Page 230 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.18 Thermographic Survey Suggested Actions Based on Temperature Rise Temperature difference ( T) based on comparisons between similar components under similar loading Temperature difference ( T) based upon comparisons between component and ambient air temperatures 1º C – 3º C 1º C – 10º C Possible deficiency; warrants investigation 4º C – 15º C 11º C – 20º C Indicates probable deficiency; repair as time permits ------ 21º C – 40º C Monitor until corrective measures can be accomplished >15º C >40º C Recommended Action Major discrepancy; repair immediately Temperature specifications vary depending on the exact type of equipment. Even in the same class of equipment (i.e., cables) there are various temperature ratings. Heating is generally related to the square of the current; therefore, the load current will have a major impact on T. In the absence of consensus standards for T, the values in this table will provide reasonable guidelines. An alternative method of evaluation is the standards-based temperature rating system as discussed in Section 8.9.2, Conducting an IR Thermographic Inspection, Electrical Power Systems Maintenance and Testing by Paul Gill, PE, 1998. It is a necessary and valid requirement that the person performing the electrical inspection be thoroughly trained and experienced concerning the apparatus and systems being evaluated as well as knowledgeable of thermographic methodology. Page 231 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.19 Dielectric Withstand Test Voltages for Electrical Apparatus Other than Inductive Equipment Nominal System (Line) Voltage a (kV) Insulation Class (kV) AC Factory Test (kV) Maximum Field Applied AC Test (kV) Maximum Field Applied DC Test (kV) 1.2 1.2 10 6.0 8.5 2.4 2.5 15 9.0 12.7 4.8 5.0 19 11.4 16.1 8.3 8.7 26 15.6 22.1 14.4 15.0 34 20.4 28.8 18.0 18.0 40 24.0 33.9 25.0 25.0 50 30.0 42.4 34.5 35.0 70 42.0 59.4 46.0 46.0 95 57.0 80.6 69.0 69.0 140 84.0 118.8 In the absence of consensus standards, the NETA Standards Review Council suggests the above representative values. a. Intermediate voltage ratings are placed in the next higher insulation class. Page 232 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.20.1 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers Operating mechanisms are designed for rated control voltages listed with operational capability throughout the indicated voltage ranges to accommodate variations in source regulation, coupled with low charge levels, as well as high charge levels maintained with floating charges. The maximum voltage is measured at the point of user connection to the circuit breaker [see notes (12) and (13)] with no operating current flowing, and the minimum voltage is measured with maximum operating current flowing. Direct Current Voltage Ranges (1)(2)(3)(5) (8)(9) (11) Rated Control Voltage Closing and Auxiliary Functions Indoor Outdoor Circuit Circuit Breakers Breakers Alternating Current Voltage Ranges (1)(2)(3)(4)(8) Rated Control Closing, Tripping, Voltage and Auxiliary (60 Hz) Functions Opening Functions All Types Single Phase Single Phase 24 (6) -- -- 14–28 120 104–127 (7) 48 (6) 38–56 36–56 28–56 240 208–254 (7) 125 100–140 90–140 70–140 250 200–280 180–280 140–280 --- --- --- --- Polyphase 208Y/120 240 Polyphase 180Y/104–220Y/127 208–254 Derived from Table 8, ANSI C37.06-2000, AC High-Voltage Circuit Breakers Rated on a Symmetrical Current Basis – Preferred Ratings and Related Required Capabilities. Page 233 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.20.1 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers Notes (1) Electrically operated motors, contactors, solenoids, valves, and the like, need not carry a nameplate voltage rating that corresponds to the control voltage rating shown in the table as long as these components perform the intended duty cycle (usually intermittent) in the voltage range specified. (2) Relays, motors, or other auxiliary equipment that function as a part of the control for a device shall be subject to the voltage limits imposed by this standard, whether mounted at the device or at a remote location. (3) Circuit breaker devices, in some applications, may be exposed to control voltages exceeding those specified here due to abnormal conditions such as abrupt changes in line loading. Such applications require specific study, and the manufacturer should be consulted. Also, application of switchgear devices containing solid-state control, exposed continuously to control voltages approaching the upper limits of ranges specified herein, require specific attention and the manufacturer should be consulted before application is made. (4) Includes supply for pump or compressor motors. Note that rated voltages for motors and their operating ranges are covered by ANSI/NEMA MG-1-1978. (5) It is recommended that the coils of closing, auxiliary, and tripping devices that are connected continually to one dc potential should be connected to the negative control bus so as to minimize electrolytic deterioration. (6) 24-volt or 48-volt tripping, closing, and auxiliary functions are recommended only when the device is located near the battery or where special effort is made to ensure the adequacy of conductors between battery and control terminals. 24volt closing is not recommended. (7) Includes heater circuits (8) Voltage ranges apply to all closing and auxiliary devices when cold. Breakers utilizing standard auxiliary relays for control functions may not comply at lower extremes of voltage ranges when relay coils are hot, as after repeated or continuous operation. (8) Voltage ranges apply to all closing and auxiliary devices when cold. Breakers utilizing standard auxiliary relays for control functions may not comply at lower extremes of voltage ranges when relay coils are hot, as after repeated or continuous operation. (9) Direct current control voltage sources, such as those derived from rectified alternating current, may contain sufficient inherent ripple to modify the operation of control devices to the extent that they may not function over the entire specified voltage ranges. (10) This table also applies to circuit breakers in gas-insulated substation installations. (11) In cases where other operational ratings are a function of the specific control voltage applied, tests in C37.09 may refer to the “Rated Control Voltage.” In these cases, tests shall be performed at the levels in this column. (12) For an outdoor circuit breaker, the point of user connection to the circuit breaker is the secondary terminal block point at which the wires from the circuit breaker operating mechanism components are connected to the user’s control circuit wiring. (13) For an indoor circuit breaker, the point of user connection to the circuit breaker is either the secondary disconnecting contact (where the control power is connected from the stationary housing to the removable circuit breaker) or the terminal block point in the housing nearest to the secondary disconnecting contact. Page 234 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.20.2 Rated Control Voltages and Their Ranges for Circuit Breakers Solenoid-Operated Devices Rated Voltage Closing Voltage Ranges for Power Supply 125 dc 90 – 115 or 105 – 130 250 dc 180 – 230 or 210 – 260 230 ac 190 – 230 or 210 – 260 Some solenoid operating mechanisms are not capable of satisfactory performance over the range of voltage specified in the standard; moreover, two ranges of voltage may be required for such mechanisms to achieve an acceptable standard of performance. The preferred method of obtaining the double range of closing voltage is by use of tapped coils. Otherwise it will be necessary to designate one of the two closing voltage ranges listed above as representing the condition existing at the device location due to battery or lead voltage drop or control power transformer regulation. Also, caution should be exercised to ensure that the maximum voltage of the range used is not exceeded. Page 235 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.21 Accuracy of IEC Class TP Current Transformers Error Limit At Rated Current Class Ratio Error (%) TPX TPY TPZ At Accuracy Limit Condition Phase Displacement Minimum ± 0.5 ± 1.0 ± 1.0 Peak Instantaneous Error (%) ± 30 ± 60 180 ± 18 10 10 10 (see note) NOTE – Alternating current component error. There are four different TP classifications to meet different functional requirements as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. Class TPS low leakage flux design ct. Class TPX closed core ct for specified transient duty cycle. Class TPY gapped (low remanance) ct for specified transient duty cycle Class TPZ linear ct (no remanence). The error limit for TPS ct in terms of turn ratio error is ± .25% and the excitation voltage under limiting conditions should not be less than the specified value; furthermore, this value is such that an increase of 10 percent in magnitude does not result in an increase in the corresponding peak instantaneous exciting current exceeding 100 percent. In other words, the ct should not be in saturated state at the specified maximum operating voltage. The accuracy limit conditions are specified on the rating plate. The required rating plate information is shown in the table below. (The obvious information such as rated primary and secondary currents is not shown.) CT Class TPS TPX TPY Symmetrical short-circuit current factor x x x x Rated resistive burden (Rb) x x x x Secondary winding resistance ( C) x x x x Rated Transient dimensioning factor - x x x Steady-state error limit factor x - - - Excitation limiting secondary voltage x - - - Accuracy limiting secondary exciting current x - - - Factor of construction* - x x x Rated secondary loop time constant - - x - Specified primary time constant (Tp) - x x x Duty cycle - x x - o TPZ x = applicable, – = not applicable *The factor construction is determined from the following ratio: Equivalent secondary accuracy limiting voltage (Vcal) Equivalent secondary accuracy limiting e.m.f (Ecal) where Vcal is the rms value of sinusoidal voltage of rated frequency, with, if applied to the secondary winding of a ct, would result in an exciting current corresponding to the maximum permissible error current appropriate to ct class Ecal is the equivalent rms emf of rated frequency determined during test observed error current corresponds to the appropriate limit for the class Derived from C37.110 Page 236 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.22 Minimum Radii for Power Cable Single and Multiple Conductor Cables with Interlocked Armor, Smooth or Corrugated Aluminum Sheath or Lead Sheath Cable Type Smooth Aluminum Sheath Single Conductor Nonshielded, Multiple Conductor or Multiplexed, with Individually Shielded Conductors Single Conductor Shielded Multiple Conductor or Multiplexed, with Overall Shield Interlocked Armor or Corrugated Aluminum Sheath Nonshielded Multiple Conductor with Individually Shielded Conductor Multiple Conductor with Overall Shield Lead Sheath Overall Diameter of Cable mm inches mm inches 190 0.76 to 191 to 1.51 and and less 1.50 381 larger Minimum Bending Radius as a Multiple of Cable Diameter inches 0.75 and less mm 382 and larger 10 12 15 12 12 15 12 12 15 7 7 7 12/7 a 12/7 a 12/7 a 12 12 12 12 12 12 ANSI/ICEA S-93-639 2006, 5-46 kV Shielded Power Cable for Use in the Transmission and Distribution of Electric Energy, Appendix I – Recommended Bending Radii for Cables and Table I1 – Minimum Radii for Power Cable. 1. 12 x individual shielded conductor diameter, or 7 x overall cable diameter, whichever is greater. Page 237 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 TABLE 100.22 Minimum Radii for Power Cable Single and Multiple Conductor Cables with Interlocked Armor, Smooth or Corrugated Aluminum Sheath or Lead Sheath Notes Specific references from Appendix I: 1. Interlocked-Armor and Metallic-Sheathed Cables 1.1 The minimum bending radius for interlocked-armored cables, smooth or corrugated aluminum sheath or lead sheath, shall be in accordance with Table 100.22. 2. Flat-Tape Armored or Wire-Armored Cables 2.1 The minimum bending radius for all flat-tape armored and all wire-armored cables is twelve times the overall diameter of cable. 3. Tape-Shielded Cables 3.1 The minimum bending radius for tape-shielded cables given above applies to helically applied flat or corrugated tape or longitudinally applied corrugated tape-shielded cables. 3.2 The minimum bending radius for a single-conductor cable is twelve times the overall diameter. 3.3 For multiple-conductor or multiplexed single-conductor cables having individually taped shielded conductors, the minimum bending radius is twelve times the diameter of the individual conductors or seven times the overall diameter, whichever is greater. 3.4 For multiple-conductor cables having an overall tape shield over the assembly, the minimum bending radius is twelve times the overall diameter of the cable. 4. Wire-Shielded Cables 4.1 The minimum bending radius for a single-conductor cable is eight times the overall diameter. 4.2 For multiple-conductor or multiplexed single-conductor cables having wire-shielded individual conductors, the minimum bending radius is eight times the diameter of the individual conductors or five times the overall diameter, whichever is greater. 4.3 For multiple-conductor cables having a wire shield over the assembly, the minimum bending radius is eight times the overall diameter of the cable. . Page 238 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – Page 239 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 – This page intentionally left blank – Page 240 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX A Definitions NETA recognizes the IEEE 100, IEEE Dictionary, as its official source for electrical definitions. The definitions in the list provided by NETA either are not included in the IEEE reference or are more specific to electrical testing and to this document. NETA defines equipment voltage ratings in accordance with ANSI/NEMA C37.84.1 American National Standard for Electrical Power Systems and Equipment – Voltage Ratings (60 Hertz). As-found Condition of the equipment when taken out of service, prior to maintenance. As-left Condition of equipment at the completion of maintenance. As-left values refer to test values obtained after all maintenance has been performed on the device under test. Comment Suggested revision, addition, or deletion in an existing section of the NETA specifications. Electrical tests Electrical tests involve application of electrical signals and observation of the response. It may be, for instance, applying a potential across an insulation system and measuring the resultant leakage current magnitude or power factor/dissipation factor. It may also involve application of voltage and/or current to metering and relaying equipment to check for correct response. Equipment condition Suitability of the equipment for continued operation in the intended environment as determined by evaluation of the results of inspections and tests. Exercise To operate equipment in such a manner that it performs all its intended functions to allow observation, testing, measurement, and diagnosis of its operational condition. Extra-high voltage A class of nominal system voltages greater than 230,000 volts. High voltage A class of nominal system voltages equal to or greater than 100,000 volts and equal to or less than 230,000 volts. Inspection Examination or measurement to verify whether an item or activity conforms to specified requirements. Interim amendment An interim amendment is made by NETA’s Standards Review Council when a potential hazard is identified with respect to the use of this document. The interim amendment is in force from the time of its issue until the next revision of the document. Page 241 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX A Definitions Low voltage A class of nominal system voltages 1000 volts or less. Manufacturer’s published data Data provided by the manufacturer concerning a specific piece of equipment. Mechanical inspection Observation of the mechanical operation of equipment not requiring electrical stimulation, such as manual operation of circuit breaker trip and close functions. It may also include tightening of hardware, cleaning, and lubricating. Medium voltage A class of nominal system voltages greater than 1000 volts and less than 100,000 volts. Proposal Draft of a section that is currently “reserved” in one of the NETA specifications. Ready-to-test condition Having the equipment which is to be tested isolated, source and load disconnected, the breaker grounded, and control and operating sources identified. Shall Indicates a mandatory requirement and is used when the testing firm has control over the result. Should Indicates that a provision is not mandatory but is recommended as good practice. This term is also used when a value is recommended and there is no practical capability of achieving that value. System voltage The root-mean-square (rms) phase-to-phase voltage of a portion of an alternating-current electric system. Each system voltage pertains to a portion of the system that is bounded by transformers or utilization equipment. Verify To investigate by observation or by test to determine that a particular condition exists. Visual inspection Qualitative observation of physical characteristics, including cleanliness, physical integrity, evidence of overheating, lubrication, etc. Page 242 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX B Frequency of Maintenance Tests NETA recognizes that the ideal maintenance program is reliability-based, unique to each plant and to each piece of equipment. In the absence of this information and in response to requests for a maintenance timetable, NETA’s Standards Review Council presents the following time-based maintenance schedule and matrix. One should contact a NETA Accredited Testing Company for a reliability-based evaluation. The following matrix is to be used in conjunction with Appendix B, Inspections and Tests. Application of the matrix is recognized as a guide only. Specific condition, criticality, and reliability must be determined to correctly apply the matrix. Application of the matrix, along with the culmination of historical testing data and trending, should provide a quality electrical preventive maintenance program. MAINTENANCE FREQUENCY MATRIX EQUIPMENT CONDITION EQUIPMENT RELIABILITY REQUIREMENT POOR AVERAGE GOOD LOW 1.0 2.0 2.5 MEDIUM 0.50 1.0 1.5 HIGH 0.25 0.50 0.75 Page 243 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX B Frequency of Maintenance Tests (continued) Inspections and Tests Frequency in Months (Multiply These Values by the Factor in the Maintenance Frequency Matrix) Section 7.1 7.2 7.2.1.1 7.2.1.2 7.2.2 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.3.3 7.4 7.5 7.5.1.1 7.5.1.2 7.5.1.3 7.5.2 7.5.3 7.5.4 7.5.5 7.6 7.6.1.1 7.6.1.2 7.6.1.3 7.6.2 7.6.2 7.6.3 7.6.4 7.7 7.8 Description Switchgear & Switchboard Assemblies Transformers Small Dry-Type Transformers Large Dry-Type Transformers Liquid-Filled Transformers Sampling Cables Low-Voltage, Low-Energy Low-Voltage, 600 Volt Maximum Medium- and High-Voltage Metal-Enclosed Busways Infrared Only Switches Air, Low-Voltage Air, Medium-Voltage, Metal-Enclosed Air, Medium- and High-Voltage Open Visual 12 Visual & Mechanical 12 Visual & Mechanical & Electrical 24 2 1 1 – 12 12 12 – 36 24 24 12 – 2 2 2 – – 12 12 12 – – 36 36 24 12 2 – 1 12 12 12 36 24 24 1 1 1 12 12 12 12 24 24 24 24 24 1 1 1 1 – 1 – 1 1 1 12 12 12 12 12 – 12 – 12 12 12 12 36 36 36 36 12 12 12 24 12 12 24 Oil, Medium-Voltage Vacuum, Medium-Voltage Medium-Voltage, SF6 Cutouts Circuit Breakers Air, Insulated-Case/Molded-Case Air, Low-Voltage Power Air, Medium-Voltage Oil, Medium-Voltage Sampling Oil, High-Voltage Sampling Vacuum, Medium-Voltage SF6 Circuit Switchers Network Protectors Page 244 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX B Frequency of Maintenance Tests (continued) Inspections and Tests Frequency in Months (Multiply These Values by the Factor in the Maintenance Frequency Matrix) Section 7.9 7.9.1 7.9.2 7.10 7.11 7.11.1 7.11.2 7.12 7.12.1.1 7.12.1.2 7.12.2 7.12.3 7.13 7.14 7.15 7.15.1 7.15.2 7.15.3 7.16 7.16.1.1 7.16.1.2 7.16.2.1 7.16.2.2 7.17 7.18 7.18.1 7.18.2 7.18.3 7.19 7.19.1 7.19.2 Description Protective Relays Electromechanical and Solid State Microprocessor-Based Instrument Transformers Metering Devices Electromechanical and Solid-State Microprocessor-Based Regulating Apparatus Step-Voltage Regulators Sample Liquid Induction Regulators Current Regulators Load Tap-changers Sample Liquid Grounding Systems Ground-Fault Protection Systems Rotating Machinery AC Induction Motors and Generators Synchronous Motors and Generators DC Motors and Generators Motor Control Motor Starters, Low-Voltage Motor Starters, Medium-Voltage Motor Control Centers, Low-Voltage Motor Control Centers, Medium-Voltage Adjustable-Speed Drive Systems Direct-Current Systems Batteries Battery Chargers Rectifiers Surge Arresters Low-Voltage Surge Protection Devices Medium- and High-Voltage Surge Protection Devices Visual Visual & Mechanical Visual & Mechanical & Electrical 1 1 12 12 12 12 12 12 36 12 12 12 12 36 36 1 – 12 1 1 – 2 2 12 – 12 12 12 – 12 12 24 12 24 24 24 12 24 12 1 1 1 12 12 12 24 24 24 2 2 2 2 1 12 12 12 12 12 24 24 24 24 24 1 1 1 12 12 12 12 12 24 2 2 12 12 24 24 Page 245 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX B Frequency of Maintenance Tests (continued) Inspections and Tests Frequency in Months (Multiply These Values by the Factor in the Maintenance Frequency Matrix) Section 7.20 7.20.1 7.20.2 7.20.3.1 7.20.3.2 7.21 7.22 7.22.1 7.22.2 7.22.3 7.23 7.24 7.24.1 7.24.2 7.27 Description Visual Capacitors and Reactors Capacitors 1 Capacitor Control Devices 1 Reactors, (Shunt and Current-Limiting) Dry2 Type Reactors, (Shunt and Current-Limiting) Liquid1 Filled Sampling – Outdoor Bus Structures 1 Emergency Systems Engine Generator 1 Functional Testing – Uninterruptible Power Systems 1 Functional Testing – Automatic Transfer Switches 1 Functional Testing – Telemetry/Pilot Wire SCADA 1 Automatic Circuit Reclosers and Line Sectionalizers Automatic Circuit Reclosers, Oil/Vacuum 1 Sample – Automatic Line Sectionalizers, Oil 1 Sample – EMF Testing 12 Page 246 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Visual & Mechanical Visual & Mechanical & Electrical 12 12 12 12 12 24 12 24 – 12 12 36 2 – 12 – 12 – 12 12 2 12 2 12 2 12 12 – 12 – 12 24 12 24 12 12 APPENDIX C About the InterNational Electrical Testing Association (This appendix is not part of American National Standard ANSI/NETA MTS-2011) The InterNational Electrical Testing Association (NETA) is an accredited standards developer for the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) and defines the standards by which electrical equipment is deemed safe and reliable. NETA Certified Technicians conduct the tests that ensure this equipment meets the Association’s stringent specifications. NETA is the leading source of specifications, procedures, testing, and requirements, not only for commissioning new equipment but for testing the reliability and performance of existing equipment. CERTIFICATION Certification of competency is particularly important in the electrical testing industry. Inherent in the determination of the equipment’s serviceability is the prerequisite that individuals performing the tests be capable of conducting the tests in a safe manner and with complete knowledge of the hazards involved. They must also evaluate the test data and make an informed judgement on the continued serviceability, deterioration, or nonserviceability of the specific equipment. NETA, a nationally-recognized certification agency, provides recognition of four levels of competency within the electrical testing industry in accordance with ANSI/NETA ETT-2010 Standard for Certification of Electrical Testing Technicians. QUALIFICATIONS OF THE TESTING ORGANIZATION An independent overview is the only method of determining the long-term usage of electrical apparatus and its suitability for the intended purpose. NETA Accredited Companies best support the interest of the owner, as the objectivity and competency of the testing firm is as important as the competency of the individual technician. NETA Accredited Companies are part of an independent, third-party electrical testing association dedicated to setting world standards in electrical maintenance and acceptance testing. Hiring a NETA Accredited Company assures the customer that: The NETA Technician has broad-based knowledge -- this person is trained to inspect, test, maintain, and calibrate all types of electrical equipment in all types of industries. NETA Technicians meet stringent educational and experience requirements in accordance with ANSI/NETA ETT-2010 Standard for Certification of Electrical Testing Technicians. A Registered Professional Engineer will review all engineering reports. All tests will be performed objectively, according to NETA specifications, using calibrated instruments traceable to the National Institute of Science and Technology (NIST). The firm is a well-established, full-service electrical testing business. Page 247 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX C About the InterNational Electrical Testing Association (continued) (This appendix is not part of American National Standard ANSI/NETA MTS-2011) SPECIFICATIONS AND PUBLICATIONS As a part of its service to the industry, the InterNational Electrical Testing Association provides nationallyrecognized publications: ANSI/NETA ETT-2010 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 Standard for Certification of Electrical Testing Technicians Standard for Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems ANSI/NETA ATS-2009 Standard for Acceptance Testing Specifications for Electrical Power Equipment and Systems The Association also produces a quarterly technical journal, NETA World, which features articles of interest to electrical testing and maintenance companies, consultants, engineers, architects, and plant personnel directly involved in electrical testing and maintenance. EDUCATIONAL PROGRAMS PowerTest, NETA's annual technical conference, draws hundreds of qualified industry professionals from around the globe. This conference provides a forum for current industry advances, critical informational updates, networking, and more. Regular attendees include technicians from electrical testing and maintenance companies, consultants, engineers, architects, and plant personnel directly involved in electrical testing and maintenance. Paper presentations from field-experienced industry experts share practical knowledge and experience while in-depth seminars offer interactive training. At the Trade Show attendees enjoy the highest-quality gathering of industry-specific suppliers displaying state-of-the-art products and services directly related to the electrical testing industry. Attendance of PowerTest is the best opportunity for interaction and input in a professional technical environment. Page 248 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX D Form for Comments (This appendix is not part of American National Standard ANSI/NETA MTS-2011) Anyone may comment on this document using this form: Type of Comment (Check one) Technical Editorial Paragraph Number Recommend (Check One) *New Text *Revised Text *Deleted Text This Comment is original material (Note: Original material is considered to be the submitter’s own idea based on or as a result of his/her own experience, thought, or research and to the best of his/her knowledge is not copied from another source.) This Comment is not original material; its source (if known) is Please Check One: User Producer General Interest Section Panel Date Name (please print) Company Address City/State/Zip Phone with area code Fax Email Organization represented, if any I hereby grant NETA the nonexclusive, royalty-free rights, including nonexclusive, royalty-free rights in copyright, in this material; I understand that I acquire no rights in any publication of NETA in which this proposal in this or another similar analogous form is used. Signature (required) *1. *2. *3. All comments must be relevant to the proposed standard. Suggested changes must include (1) proposed text, including the wording to be added, revised (and how revised), or deleted, (2) a statement of the problem and substantiation for a technical change, and (3) signature of submitter. (Note: State the problem that will be resolved by your recommendation; give the specific reason for your comment, including copies of texts, research papers, testing experience, etc. If more than 200 words, it may be abstracted for publication.) Editorial comments are welcome, but they cannot serve as the sole basis for a suggested change. A comment that does not include all required information may be rejected by the Standards Review Council for that reason. Must use separate form for each comment. All comments must be typed or printed neatly. Illegible comments will be interpreted to the best of the staff’s ability. This form is available electronically on NETA’s website at www.netaworld.org under Standards Activities. Send to: Standards Review Council 3050 Old Centre Avenue, Suite 102, Portage, MI 49024 Phone: 888.300.6382 FAX: 269.488.6383 Email: neta@netaworld.org Page 249 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011 APPENDIX E Form for Proposals (This appendix is not part of American National Standard ANSI/NETA MTS-2011) Anyone may propose a new section for this document using the following form: When drafting a proposed section: Use the most recent edition of the specifications as a guideline for format and wording. Remember that NETA specifications are “what to do” documents and do not include “how to do” information. Include references. When applicable, use the standard base format: 1. Visual and Mechanical Inspection 2. Electrical Tests 3. Test Values Date Name Company Address Please indicate organization represented (if any) NETA document title Section/Number Tel No. Fax No. E-Mail Year Note 1: Type or print legibly in black ink. Note 2: If supplementary material (photographs, diagrams, reports, etc.) is included, you may be required to submit sufficient copies for all Members and Alternates of the Section Panel. I hereby grant NETA the nonexclusive, royalty-free rights, including nonexclusive, royalty-free rights in copyright, in this proposal. I understand that I acquire no rights in any publication of NETA in which this proposal in this or another similar analogous form is used. Signature (required) This form is available electronically on NETA’s website at www.netaworld.org under Standards Activities. Send to: Standards Review Council 3050 Old Centre Avenue, Suite 102 Portage, MI 49024 Phone: 888.300.6382 FAX: 269.488.6383 Email: neta@netaworld.org Page 250 ANSI/NETA MTS-2011